AT83C5122XXX-PSVIM [ATMEL]
Microcontroller, 8-Bit, MROM, 8051 CPU, 24MHz, CMOS, QFN-64;型号: | AT83C5122XXX-PSVIM |
厂家: | ATMEL |
描述: | Microcontroller, 8-Bit, MROM, 8051 CPU, 24MHz, CMOS, QFN-64 微控制器 |
文件: | 总213页 (文件大小:2661K) |
中文: | 中文翻译 | 下载: | 下载PDF数据表文档文件 |
Features
• Clock Controller
– 80C51 core with 6 clocks per instruction
– 8 MHz On-Chip Oscillator
– PLL for generating clock to supply CPU core, USB and Smart Card Interfaces
– Programmable CPU clock from 500 KHz / X1 to 48 MHz / X1
• Reset Controller
– Power On Reset (POR) feature avoiding an external reset capacitor
– Power Fail Detector (PFD)
– Watch-Dog Timer
• Power Management
C51
– Two power saving modes : Idle and Power Down
– Four Power Down Wake-up Sources : Smart Card Detection, Keyboard Interrupt, USB
Resume, External Interrupt
Microcontroller
with USB and
Smart Card
Reader
– Input Voltage Range : 3.6V - 5.5V
– Core’s Power Consumption (Without Smart Card and USB) :
•30 mA Maximum Operating Current @ 48 MHz / X1
•200 µA Maximum Power-down Current @ 5.5V
• Interrupt Controller
– up to 9 interrupt sources
– up to 4 Level Priority
• Memory Controller
Interfaces
– Internal Program memory :
•up to 32KB of Flash or CRAM or ROM for AT8xC5122
•up to 30KB of ROM for AT83C5123
– Internal Data Memory : 768 bytes including 256 bytes of data and 512 bytes of XRAM
– Optional : internal data E2PROM 512 bytes
• Two 16-bit Timer/Counters
AT83C5122
AT83EC5122
AT85C5122
AT89C5122
AT89C5122DS
AT83C5123
AT83EC5123
• USB 2.0 Full Speed Interface
– 48 MHz DPLL
– On-Chip 3.3V USB voltage regulator and transceivers
– Software detach feature
– 7 endpoints programmable with In or out directions and ISO, Bulk or Interrupt Transfers :
•Endpoint 0: 32 Bytes Bidirectionnal FIFO for Control transfers
•Endpoints 1,2,3: 8 bytes FIFO
•Endpoints 4,5: 64 Bytes FIFO
•Endpoint 6: 2*64 bytes FIFO with Pin-Pong feature
• ISO 7816 UART Interface Fully Compliant with EMV, GIE-CB and WHQL Standards
– Programmable ISO clock from 1 MHz to 4.8 MHz
– Card insertion/removal detection with automatic deactivation sequence
– Programmable Baud Rate Generator from 372 to 11.625 clock pulses
– Synchronous/Asynchronous Protocols T=0 and T=1 with Direct or Inverse Convention
– Automatic character repetition on parity errors
– 32 Bit Waiting Time Counter
– 16 Bit Guard Time Counter
– Internal Step Up/Down Converter with Programmable Voltage Output :
•1.8V-30 mA, 3V-60 mA and 5V-60 mA
– Current overload protection
– 6 kV ESD (MIL/STD 833 Class 3) protection on whole Smart Card Interface
• Alternate Smart Card Interface with CLK, IO and RST
• UART Interface with Integrated Baud Rate Generator (BRG)
• Keyboard interface with up to 20x8 matrix management capability
• Master/Slave SPI Interface
• Four 8 bit Ports, one 6 bit port, one 3-bit port
– Up to Seven LED outputs with 3 level programmable current source : 2, 4 and 10 mA
– Two General Purpose I/O programmable as external interrupts
– Up to 8 input lines programmable as interrupts
– Up to 30 output lines
Rev. 4202D–SCR–06/05
1
Reference Documents
The user must get the following additionnal documents which are not included but which
complete this product datasheet
•
•
Product Errata Sheet
Bootloader Datasheet
2
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Product Description
AT8xC5122/23 products are high-performance CMOS derivatives of the 80C51 8-bit
microcontrollers designed for USB smart card reader applications.
The AT8xC5122 is proposed in four versions :
- ROM version with or without internal data E2PROM. The ROM device is only factory
programmable.
- CRAM version without internal data E2PROM. The CRAM device implements a vola-
tile program memory which is programmed by means of an embedded ROMed
bootloader which transfers the code from a remote software programming tool called
FLIP through UART or USB interfaces.
- Flash version without internal data E2PROM. At power-up, the program located in the
flash memory is transferred into the CRAM then executed.
The AT83C5123 is a low pin count of the AT8xC5122 and is proposed in ROM version
with or without internal data E2PROM. The ROM device is only factory programmable.
The AT8xC5122DS is a secure version of the AT8xC5122 on which the external pro-
gram memory access mode is disabled.
3
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 1. Product versions
Features
AT83C5122
AT83EC5122
AT85C5122
AT89C5122
AT89C5122DS
AT83C5123 AT83EC5123
VQFP64
QFN64
PLCC28
Die Form
PLCC68
VQFP64
PLCC28
Die Form
VQFP32
QFN32
VQFP32
PLCC28
PLCC28
Die Form
VQFP64
QFN64
PLCC28
VQFP64
PLCC28
VQFP64
QFN64
QFN32
Packages
32KB
E2PROM
Program memory
32KB ROM
30KB ROM
32KB CRAM
32KB E2PROM
30KB ROM
30KB ROM
Internal Data E2PROM
Embedded bootloader
No
No
512 Bytes
No
No
No
No
No
No
512 Bytes
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
Features not available :
- Keyboard Interface
- Master/Slave SPI
Interface
- External Program Memory
Access
VQFP32,
QFN32
packages
Reduced features :
- Only 12 I/O with up to 4
LED Outputs with
Programmable Current
All features are
available
except External
Program Memory
Access
Features
PLCC68,
All features are available
VQFP64,QFN64
packages
Features not available :
- Alternate Smart Card Interface
- Keyboard Interface
PLCC28 package
- Master/Slave SPI Interface
- External Program Memory Access
Reduced features :
- Only 7 I/O with up to 4 LED Outputs with Programmable Current
Note:
The PLCC28 pinout is common to AT8xC5122 and AT83C5123 products
4
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
AT8xC5122 Block Diagram
3.3 V
Regulator
XTAL1
XTAL2
8 MHz
Oscillator
256 x 8
RAM
512 x 8
XRAM
UART
Interf ace
16-BIT
TIMERS
Interrupt
Controller
Alternate
Card
DC/DC
Converter
CPRES
CRST
CCLK
CIO
PLLF
RST
PLL
INTERNALADDRESSANDDATABUS
CC4
CC8
WATCH-DOG
POR
PFD
RESET
32K x 8
ROM(1)
32K x 8
CRAM(1)
32K x 8
SPI
Interface
ExternalMemory
Controller
USB
Interface
3.3V
Regulator
E2PROM(1)
512 x 8
E2PROM(1)
ParallelI/OPorts
8-BIT
PORT
3-BIT
PORT
8-BIT
PORT
8-BIT
PORT
6-BIT
PORT
8-BIT
PORT
KBD
Interf ace
LED's
Note 1 : the implementation of these features dependson product versions
AT83C5123 Block Diagram
3.3 V
Regulator
XTAL1
XTAL2
8 MHz
Oscillator
256 x 8
RAM
512 x 8
XRAM
UART
Interface
16-BIT
TIMERS
Interrupt
Controller
Alternate
Card
DC/DC
Conv erter
CPRES
CRST
CCLK
CIO
PLLF
RST
PLL
INTERNALADDRESSANDDATABUS
CC4
CC8
WATCH-DOG
POR
PFD
RESET
30K x 8
ROM
512 x 8
E2PROM(1)
USB
3.3V
Regulator
Interface
ParallelI/OPorts
3-BIT
PORT
8-BIT
PORT
1-BIT
PORT
LED's
Note 1 : the implementation of these features dependson product versions
5
4202D–SCR–06/05
Pinout
High Pin Count Package
Description
AT8xC5122 version
Figure 1. VQFP64 Package Pinout
64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
DVCC
P1.2/CPRES
CC8
P3.1/TxD
P1.6/SS
P2.7/A15
48
47
46
45
P5.7/KB7
P5.6/KB6
CRST
P5.5/KB5
P5.4/KB4
CC4
P3.0/RxD
P3.5/T1/CRST1
P3.2/INT0/LED0/CIO1
P4.0/MISO
P3.3/INT1
P4.1/MOSI
P3.4/T0/LED1
P4.2/SCK
P4.3/LED4
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
VQFP64
P5.3/KB3
P5.2/KB2 11
CCLK
12
13
P3.6/WR/LED2
35 P4.4/LED5
P5.1/KB1
P5.0/KB0
36
14
34
PSEN
VSS
15
16
RST
P4.5/LED6
33
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
6
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 2. PLCC68 Package Pinout (for engineering purpose only)
66
64
63 62 61
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1 68 67
65
60 N/A
DVCC 10
P3.1/TxD
59
P1.2/CPRES
11
12
58 P1.6/SS
57 P2.7/A15
56 P3.0/RxD
CC8
P5.7/KB7 13
P5.6/KB6
14
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
CRST
P5.5/KB5 16
P3.5/T1/CRST1
P3.2/INT0/LED0/CIO1
P4.0/MISO
P3.3/INT1
P4.1/MOSI
15
P5.4/KB4
CC4
P5.3/KB3
P5.2/KB2
CCLK
17
18
19
20
21
PLCC68
P3.4/T0/LED1
P4.2/SCK
P5.1/KB1 22
48 P4.3/LED4
47 P3.6/WR/LED2
P5.0/KB0 23
P4.4/LED5
46
PSEN
24
45 RST
44 P4.5/LED6
VSS 25
NC 26
27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43
NC : not connected
N/A : not available
7
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 3. QFN64 Package Pinout
64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
DVCC
P1.2/CPRES
CC8
P3.1/TxD
P1.6/SS
P2.7/A15
48
47
46
45
P5.7/KB7
P5.6/KB6
CRST
P5.5/KB5
P5.4/KB4
CC4
P3.0/RxD
P3.5/T1/CRST1
P3.2/INT0/LED0/CIO1
P4.0/MISO
P3.3/INT1
P4.1/MOSI
P3.4/T0/LED1
P4.2/SCK
P4.3/LED4
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
QFN64
P5.3/KB3
P5.2/KB2 11
CCLK
12
13
P3.6/WR/LED2
P4.4/LED5
RST
P5.1/KB1
P5.0/KB0
36
35
34
14
PSEN
VSS
15
16
33
P4.5/LED6
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
8
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
AT89C5122DS version
Figure 4. VQFP64 Package Pinout
64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
DVCC
P1.2/CPRES
CC8
P3.1/TxD
P1.6/SS
P2.7/A15
48
47
46
45
P5.7/KB7
P5.6/KB6
CRST
P5.5/KB5
P5.4/KB4
CC4
P3.0/RxD
P3.5/T1/CRST1
P3.2/INT0/LED0/CIO1
P4.0/MISO
P3.3/INT1
P4.1/MOSI
P3.4/T0/LED1
P4.2/SCK
P4.3/LED4
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
VQFP64
P5.3/KB3
P5.2/KB2 11
CCLK
12
13
P3.6/WR/LED2
P4.4/LED5
RST
P5.1/KB1
P5.0/KB0
36
35
34
14
PSEN
VSS
15
16
33
P4.5/LED6
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
9
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 5. QFN64 Package Pinout
64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
DVCC
P1.2/CPRES
CC8
P3.1/TxD
P1.6/SS
P2.7/A15
48
47
46
45
P5.7/KB7
P5.6/KB6
CRST
P5.5/KB5
P5.4/KB4
CC4
P3.0/RxD
P3.5/T1/CRST1
P3.2/INT0/LED0/CIO1
P4.0/MISO
P3.3/INT1
P4.1/MOSI
P3.4/T0/LED1
P4.2/SCK
P4.3/LED4
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
QFN64
P5.3/KB3
P5.2/KB2 11
CCLK
12
13
P3.6/WR/LED2
P4.4/LED5
RST
P5.1/KB1
P5.0/KB0
36
35
34
14
PSEN
VSS
15
16
33
P4.5/LED6
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
10
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Low Pin Count Package
Description
AT8xC5122 and AT83C5123
versions
Figure 6. PLCC28 Package Pinout
4 3 2 1 28 27 26
DVCC
P1.2/CPRES
CC8
P3.1/TxD
P3.0/RxD
P3.2/INT0/LED0
P3.3/INT1
P3.4/T0/LED1
P3.6/LED2
25
24
23
22
21
20
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
CRST
CC4
CCLK
VSS
PLCC28
19 RST
12 1314 15 16 17 18
AT83C5123 version
Figure 7. VQFP32 Package Pinout
32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25
DVCC
P1.2/CPRES
CC8
P3.1/TxD
P1.6
P3.0/RxD
P3.5/T1/CRST1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
24
23
22
21
CRST
CC4
CCLK
P5.0
VQFP32
20 P3.2/INT0/LED0/CIO1
P3.3/INT1
19
P3.4/T0/LED1
18
VSS
17 P3.6/LED2
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
11
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 8. QFN32 Package Pinout
32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25
DVCC
P1.2/CPRES
CC8
P3.1/TxD
P1.6
P3.0/RxD
P3.5/T1/CRST1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
24
23
22
21
CRST
CC4
CCLK
P5.0
QFN32
20 P3.2/INT0/LED0/CIO1
P3.3/INT1
19
P3.4/T0/LED1
18
VSS
17 P3.6/LED2
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
12
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Pin Description
Table 2. Pin Description
Internal
Power
Supply ESD
Reset
Level
Reset
Port
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
Alt
Config
Conf 1
Conf 2
Conf 3
Led
P0.0
P0.1
P0.2
P0.3
P0.4
P0.5
P0.6
P0.7
30
29
28
27
25
24
23
22
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
41
40
39
38
36
35
34
33
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
30
29
28
27
25
24
23
22
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
Float
Float
Float
Float
Float
Float
Float
Float
AD0
AD1
AD2
AD3
AD4
AD5
AD6
AD7
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
P0
KB_OUT Push-pull
KB_OUT Push-pull
KB_OUT Push-pull
KB_OUT Push-pull
KB_OUT Push-pull
KB_OUT Push-pull
KB_OUT Push-pull
KB_OUT Push-pull
CVCC inactive at reset.
ESD tested with a 10µF on CVCC
CIO
64
32
9
4
64
32
CVCC 6KV
CVCC 6KV
I/O
0
Port51
An external pull-up of 10K is
recommended to support ICC’s
with too high internal pull-ups.
CVCC inactive at reset
ESD tested with a 10µF on CVCC
CC4
P1.2
3
2
3
2
5
6
4
12
11
18
21
15
7
6
3
2
3
2
5
6
4
I/O
I/O
I/O
O
0
1
0
0
0
Port51
Port51
Weak & medium pull-up can be
disconnected
VCC
2KV
CPRES
CVCC inactive at reset
ESD tested with a 10µF on CVCC
CC4
9
9
9
CVCC 6KV
CVCC 6KV
CVCC 6KV
Port51
CVCC inactive at reset
ESD tested with a 10µF on CVCC
CCLK
CRST
12
6
10
8
12
6
Push-pull
Push-pull
CVCC inactive at reset
ESD tested with a 10µF on CVCC
O
P1.6
P1.7
P2.0
P2.1
P2.2
P2.3
P2.4
P2.5
47
62
58
57
56
52
51
50
23
31
-
58
7
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
47
62
58
57
56
52
51
50
23
31
-
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
SS
CCLK1
A8
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Input
Push-pull KB_OUT
WPU
3
Input
Push-pull KB_OUT
WPU
-
2
-
A9
Input
Push-pull KB_OUT
WPU
-
1
-
A10
A11
A12
A13
Input
Push-pull KB_OUT
WPU
-
65
64
63
-
Input
Push-pull KB_OUT
WPU
-
-
Input
Push-pull KB_OUT
WPU
-
-
13
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 2. Pin Description (Continued)
Internal
Power
Supply ESD
Reset
Level
Reset
Port
I/O
Alt
Config
Conf 1
Conf 2
Conf 3
Led
Input
WPU
P2.6
P2.7
P3.0
49
46
45
-
-
62
57
56
-
-
49
46
45
-
-
VCC
VCC
VCC
2KV
2KV
2KV
I/O
1
1
1
A14
Port51
Port51
Port51
Push-pull KB_OUT
Push-pull KB_OUT
Push-pull KB_OUT
Push-pull KB_OUT
Input
WPU
I/O
I/O
A15
RxD
Input
WPU
22
24
22
Input
WPU
P3.1
P3.2
P3.3
48
43
41
24
20
19
59
54
52
25
23
22
48
43
41
24
20
19
VCC
VCC
VCC
2KV
2KV
2KV
I/O
I/O
I/O
1
1
1
TxD
INT0
INT1
Port51
Port51
Port51
LED0
LED1
Input
WPU
Push-pull KB_OUT
Push-pull KB_OUT
Input
WPU
P3.4
P3.5
P3.6
P3.7
P4.0
P4.1
P4.2
P4.3
P4.4
P4.5
P5.0
P5.1
P5.2
P5.3
P5.4
39
44
36
26
42
40
38
37
35
33
14
13
11
10
8
18
21
17
13
-
50
55
47
37
53
51
49
48
46
44
23
22
20
19
17
21
-
39
44
36
26
42
40
38
37
35
33
14
13
11
10
8
18
21
17
13
-
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
2KV
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
I/O
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
T0
T1
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
Port51
20
16
-
WR
LED2
LED3
RD
MISO
MOSI
SCK
-
-
-
-
-
-
Input
MPU
-
-
-
Push-pull KB_OUT
Push-pull KB_OUT
Push-pull KB_OUT
LED4
LED5
LED6
Input
MPU
-
-
-
Input
MPU
-
-
-
Input
Push-pull
Input
WPU
7
-
-
7
-
KB0
KB1
KB2
KB3
KB4
MPU
Input
Push-pull
Input
WPU
-
MPU
Input
Push-pull
Input
WPU
-
-
-
MPU
Input
Push-pull
Input
WPU
-
-
-
WPD
Input
Push-pull
Input
WPU
-
-
-
WPD
14
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 2. Pin Description (Continued)
Internal
Power
Supply ESD
Reset
Level
Reset
Port
I/O
Alt
Config
Conf 1
Conf 2
Conf 3
Led
Input
WPD
Input
WPU
P5.5
P5.6
P5.7
7
5
4
-
-
-
16
14
13
-
-
-
7
5
4
-
-
-
VCC
VCC
VCC
2KV
2KV
2KV
I/O
1
1
1
KB5
Port51
Port51
Port51
Push-pull
Input
WPD
Input
WPU
I/O
I/O
KB6
Push-pull
Push-pull
Input
WPD
Input
WPU
KB7
Reset Input
The Port pins are driven to their reset conditions when a voltage
lower than VIL is applied, whether or not the oscillator is running.
This pin has an internal 10K pull-up resistor which allows the device
to be reset by connecting a capacitor between this pin and VSS.
Asserting RST when the chip is in Idle mode or Power-Down mode
returns the chip to normal operation.
The output is active for at least 12 oscillator periods when an internal
reset occurs.
RST
D+
34
16
45
19
34
16
VCC
I/0
USB Positive Data Upstream Port
This pin requires an external serial resistor of 27Ω (AT8xC122) or
60
59
29
28
5
4
2
1
60
59
29
28
DVCC
DVCC
I/O
I/O
33Ω (AT83C5123) and a 1.5 K
configuration.
Ω
pull-up to VREF for full speed
USB Negative Data Upstream Port
This pin requires an external serial resistor of 27Ω (AT8xC122) or
33Ω (AT83C5123)
D-
USB Voltage Reference: 3.0 < VREF < 3.6 V
61
31
32
30
14
15
6
3
61
31
32
30
14
15
AVCC
VCC
VCC
O
I
VREF
VREF can be connected to D+ through a 1.5 K
voltage is controlled by software.
Ω
resistor. The VREF
Input to the on-chip inverting oscillator amplifier
To use the internal oscillator, a crystal or an external oscillator must
be connected to this pin.
XTAL
1
42
43
17
18
Output of the on-chip inverting oscillator amplifier
XTAL
2
O
To use the internal oscillator, a crystal circuit must be connected to
this pin. If an external oscillator is used, leave XTAL2 unconnected.
External Access Enable (Only AT8xC5122)
EA must be strapped to ground in order to enable the device to fetch
code from external memory locations 0000h to FFFFh.
EA/
If security level 1 is programmed, EA will be latched on reset.
63
21
-
-
8
-
-
63
21
-
-
VCC
VCC
I
VCC
Warning : EA pin cannot be left floating. If the External Access
Enable mode is not used, EA pin must be strapped to VCC. If this last
condition is not met,the MCU may have an unpredictable behaviour.
VCC (Only AT89C5122DS)
Address Latch Enable/Program Pulse: Output pulse for latching
the low byte of the address during an access to external memory. In
normal operation, ALE is emitted at a constant rate of 1/6 (1/3 in X2
mode) the oscillator frequency, and can be used for external timing or
clocking. Note that one ALE pulse is skipped during each access to
external data memory. ALE can be disabled by setting SFR’s
AUXR.0 bit. With this bit set, ALE will be inactive during internal
fetches
ALE
32
O
15
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 2. Pin Description (Continued)
Internal
Power
Supply ESD
Reset
Level
Reset
Port
I/O
Alt
Config
Conf 1
Conf 2
Conf 3
Led
Program Strobe Enable: The read strobe to external program
memory. When executing code from the external program memory,
PSEN is activated twice each machine cycle, except that two PSEN
activations are skipped during each access to external data memory.
PSEN is not activated during fetches from internal program memory.
PSEN
15
-
24
-
15
-
VCC
O
PLL Low Pass Filter input
PLLF
54
55
26
27
67
68
27
28
54
55
26
27
AVCC
O
Receives the RC network of the PLL low pass filter.
Analog Supply Voltage
AVCC is used to supply the internal 3.3V analog regulator which
supplies the internal USB driver
AVCC
PWR
Supply Voltage
VCC is used to supply the internal 3.3V digital regulator which
supplies the PLL, CPU core and internal I/O’s
VCC
LI
20
18
12
10
31
29
15
13
20
18
12
10
PWR
PWR
DC/DC Input
LI supplies the current for the charge pump of the DC/DC converter.
- LI tied directly to VCC : the DC/DC converter must be configured in
regulator mode.
- LI tied to VCC through an external 10µH coil : the DC/DC converter
can be configured either in regulator or in pump mode.
Card Supply Voltage
CVCC is the ouput of internal DC/DC converter which supplies the
Smart Card Interface. It must be connected to an external decoupling
capacitor of 10 µF with the lowest ESR as this parameter influences
on the CVCC noise
CVCC 17
9
1
28
10
12
5
17
1
9
1
PWR
PWR
Digital Supply Voltage
DVCC is the output of the internal analog 3.3V regulator which
supplies the USB driver. This pin must be connected to an external
680nF decoupling capacitor if the USB interface is used.
DVCC
1
This output can be used by the application with a maximum of 10 mA.
DC/DC Ground
CVSS is used to sink high shunt currents from the external coil
CVSS
VSS
19
16
53
11
8
30
25
66
14
11
26
19
16
53
11
8
GND
GND
GND
Digital Ground
VSS is used to supply the PLL, buffer ring and the digital core
Analog Ground
AVSS
25
25
AVSS is used to supply the USB driver.
16
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Typical Applications
Recommended External components
All the external components described in the figure and table below must be imple-
mented as close as possible from the microcontroller package.
Table 3. External Components Bill Of Materials
Reference Description
Value
Comments
R1
USB Full Speed Pull-up
1.5 KΩ +/-10%
27 Ω +/-10%
33 Ω +/-10%
27 Ω +/-10%
33 Ω +/-10%
1.8 KΩ +/-10%
10 KΩ +/10%
100 nF +80/-20%
33 pF +/-10%
150 pF +/-10%
All product versions
For AT8xC5122 versions
For AT83C5123 versions
For AT8xC5122 versions
For AT83C5123 versions
All product versions
All product versions
All product versions
All product versions
All product versions
R2
USB pad serial resistor
USB pad serial resistor
R3
R4
R5
C1
C2
C3
PLL filter resistor
CIO Pull-up resistor
Power Supply filter capacitor
PLL filter capacitor
PLL filter capacitor
All product versions.
If USB interface is not used, this capacitor is optional
C4
C5
C6
C7
USB pad decoupling capacitor
680 nF +/-30%
27 pF +/-10%
Smart Card clock filter capacitor
DC/DC Converter decoupling capacitor
DC/DC Converter filter capacitor
All product versions.
10 µF +/-10%
Low ESR
All product versions.
This capacitor does not impact the USB Inrush Current
100 nF +80/-20%
All product versions
All products versions
This capacitor impacts the USB Inrush Current. Maximum
application capacitance allowed by the USB standard is 10 µF.
C8
Power Supply decoupling capacitor
4.7 µF +/-10%
C9
Power Supply filter capacitor
Reset capacitor
100 nF +80/-20C
10 µF +/-10%
All product versions
C10
Optional capacitor for all product versions
10 µH +/- 10%
All product versions.
L1
DC/DC converter input inductance
Crystal
Min rated current : 200 mA Qualified component : Murata LQH32CN100K21L
Min rated freq. : 4 MHz
If DC/DC converter is not used at 5V, this inductance is optional.
8.0000 Mhz +/- 2500 ppm
max
ESR max : 100 Ω
Q1
All product versions
17
4202D–SCR–06/05
USB Keyboard with Smart Card Reader Using the AT8xC5122 and AT89C5122DS Versions
VCC
VCC
C9
C8
C1
GND
GND
AVCC
LEDx
GND
VCC
VCC
VCC
VCC
EA/VCC (1)
DVCC
10mA Max
L1
C4
LI
GND
Smart Card
R1
R2
R3
C6
C7
VCC
GND
C1
USB
VREF
CVCC
CVSS
VCC
VBUS
C5
GND
D+
D+
D-
GND
C2
RST
CRST
CCLK
CC4
D-
C3
C4
C7
C8
CLK
C4
GND
CIO
I/O
C8
CC8
S1 S1
CPRES
S2
R5
C0
KB0
KB1
KB2
KB3
KB4
KB5
KB6
KB7
C1
C2
C3
C4
C5
C6
C7
GND
VCC
Alternate Card
C1
VCC
C2
CRST1
RST
C3
CLK
CCLK1
CIO1
C7
I/O
C5
GND
P3[0-1,3-4]
P2[0-7]
P0[0-7]
GND
Keyboard Matrix
RST
Optional
C10
PLLF
Capacitor
GND
VSS XTAL1 XTAL2
AVSS
R4
C3
C2
Q1
GND
GND
Notes :
1 - Pin configuration depends on product versions
18
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
USB Smart Card Reader Using the AT83C5123 Version
VCC
VCC
C9
C8
C1
GND
EA
GND
AVCC
LEDx
GND
VCC
VCC
VCC
10mA Max
VCC
DVCC
L1
C4
LI
GND
Smart Card
C6
C7
C1
R1
R2
R3
CVCC
CVSS
VCC
VCC
GND
USB
VREF
C5
GND
VBUS
D+
D+
D-
GND
C2
CRST
CCLK
CC4
RST
C3
CLK
D-
C4
C4
GND
C7
I/O
CIO
C8
C8
CC8
S1 S1
CPRES
S2
R5
GND
VCC
Alternate Card
C1
C2
C3
C7
C5
VCC
RST
CLK
I/O
CRST1
CCLK1
CIO1
GND
GND
PLLF
RST
Optional
C10
Capacitor
VSS XTAL1 XTAL2
R4
C3
AVSS
C2
GND
Q1
GND
GND
19
4202D–SCR–06/05
Memory Organization The AT8xC5122/23 devices have separated address spaces for Program and Data
Memory, as shown in Figure 13 on page 29, Figure 14 on page 31 and Figure 15 on
page 32. The logical separation of Program and Data memory allows the Data Memory
to be accessed by 8-bit addresses, which can be more quickly stored and manipulated
by an-bit CPU. Nevertheless, 16-bit Data Memory addresses can also be generated
through the DPTR register.
Program Memory
Managament
Depending on the state of EA pin, the MCU fetches the code from internal or external
program memory (ROMless mode)
Warning : the EA pin can not be left floating, otherwise MCU may have an unpredict-
able behaviour.
If EA is strapped to VCC, the MCU fetches the code from the internal program memory.
The way the MCU works in this mode depends on the device version. See next para-
graphs for further details.
If the EA is strapped to GND, the MCU fetches the code from external program memory.
This mode is common for all device versions wich supports it. After reset, the CPU
begins the execution from location 0000h. There can be up to 64 KBytes of program
memory. In this mode, the internal program memories are disabled.
The hardware configuration for external program execution is shown in Figure 9.
Figure 9. Executing from External Program Memory
EXTERNAL PROGRAM
AT8xC5122
MEMORY
A15:8
P2
A15:8
ALE
P0
AD7:0
Latch A7:0
A7:0
D7:0
OE
PSEN#
Note that the 16 I/O lines (Ports 0 and 2) are dedicated to bus functions during external
Program Memory fetches. Port 0 serves as a multiplexed address/dat bus. It emits the
low byte of the Program Counter (PCL) as an address, and then goes into a float state
awaiting the arrival of the code byte from the Program Memory. During the time that the
low byte of the Program Counter is valid on P0, the signal ALE (Address Latch Enable)
clocks the byte into an address latch. Meanwhile, Port 2 emits the high byte of the Pro-
gram Counter (PCH). Then PSEN strobes the External Program Memory and the code
byte is read into the MCU.
PSEN is not activated and Ports P0 and P2 are not affected during internal program
fetches.
20
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Data Memory
Managament
All device versions implements :
- 256 Bytes of RAM to increase data parameter handling and high level language usage
- 512 bytes of XRAM (Extended RAM) to store program data.
RAM Achitecture
The internal RAM is mapped into three separate segments :
•
The Lower 128 bytes (addresses 00h to 7Fh) are directly and indirectly
addressable.
•
•
The Upper 128 bytes (addresses 80h to FFh) are indirectly addressable only.
The Special Function Registers (SFRs) (addresses 80h to FFh) are directly
addressable only.
The Upper 128 bytes and SFR’s have the same address space but are physically
separated.
When an instruction accesses an internal location above address 7Fh, the CPU knows
whether the access is in the upper 128 bytes of data RAM or to SFR space by the
addressing mode used in the instruction.
•
Instructions that use direct addressing access SFR space. For example: MOV
0A0H, # data, accesses the SFR at location 0A0h (which is P2).
•
Instructions that use indirect addressing access the Upper 128 bytes of data RAM.
For example: MOV @R0, # data where R0 contains 0A0h, accesses the data byte
at address 0A0h, rather than P2 (whose address is 0A0h).
The stack pointer (SP) may be located anywhere in the 256 bytes RAM (lower and
upper RAM) internal data memory. The stack may not be located in the XRAM.
The M0 bit allows to stretch the XRAM timings. If M0 is set, the read and write pulses
are extended from 6 to 30 clock periods. This is useful to access external slow
peripherals.
XRAM Achitecture
Depending on the state of EXTRAM bit in AUXR register (See Table 5 on page 24), the
MCU fetches data from internal or external XRAM.
If EXTRAM=0 (reset condition), the MCU fetches the data from internal XRAM. The size
of internal XRAM is configured by the bit XRS0 in AUXR register (See Table 5 on page
24).
Table 4. XRAM Size Configuration
Address
XRS0
XRAM size
Start
000h
000h
End
256 Bytes
(Reset condition)
0
1
0FFh
1FFh
512 bytes
The XRAM logically occupies the first bytes of external data memory. The bit XRS0 can
be used to hide a part of the available XRAM . This can be useful if external peripherals
are mapped at addresses already used by the internal XRAM.
The XRAM is indirectly addressed, using the MOVX instruction in combination with any
of the registers R0, R1 of the selected bank or DPTR.
For example, MOVX @R0, # data where R0 contains 0A0H, accesses the XRAM at
address 0A0H rather than external memory.
21
4202D–SCR–06/05
An access to external XRAM memory locations higher than the accessible size of the
memory (roll-over feature) will be performed with the MOVX DPTR instructions, with P0
and P2 as data/address busses, WR and RD as respectively write and read signals.
Accesses above XRAM size can only be done by the use of DPTR.
If EXTRAM=1 the MCU fetches the data from external XRAM Memory. There can be up
to 64 KBytes of external XRAM Memory.
The hardware configuration for external Data Memory Access is shown in Figure 10
Figure 10. Accessing to External XRAM Memory
EXTERNAL XRAM
AT8xC5122/23
MEMORY
A15:8
P2
A15:8
ALE
P0
AD7:0
Latch A7:0
A7:0
D7:0
RD#
WR#
OE
WR
MOVX @Ri and MOVX @DPTR will be similar to the standard 80C51. MOVX @ Ri will
provide an eight-bit address multiplexed with data on Port 0 and any output port pins
can be used to output higher order address bits. This is to provide the external paging
capability. MOVX @DPTR will generate a sixteen-bit address. Port 2 outputs the high-
order eight address bits (DPH) while Port0 multiplexes the low-order eight address bits
(DPL) with data. MOVX @ Ri and MOVX @DPTR will generate either read or write sig-
nals on WR and RD.
Ports P0, P2 are not affected and RD, WR signals are not activated during access to
internal XRAM.
Note that external XRAM Memory access is only available on High Pin Count Packages.
External Program Memory and external XRAM Memory may be combined if desired by
applying the RD and PSEN signals to the inputs of an AND gate and using the ouput of
the gate as the read strobe to the external program/data memory.
RD
STROBE
PSEN
Dual Data Pointer
Register (DDPTR)
The additional data pointer can be used to speed up code execution and reduce code
size.
The dual DPTR structure is a way by which the chip will specify the address of an exter-
nal data memory location. There are two 16-bit DPTR registers that address the external
memory, and a single bit called DPS = AUXR1.0 (see Table 7) that allow the program
code to switch between them (Figure 11).
22
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 11. Use of Dual Pointer
External Data Memory
7
0
DPS
DPTR1
DPTR0
AUXR1(A2H)
DPH(83H) DPL(82H)
a. Bit 2 stuck at 0; this allows to use INC AUXR1 to toggle DPS without changing GF3.
Assembly Language
; Block move using dual data pointers
; Modifies DPTR0, DPTR1, A and PSW
; note: DPS exits opposite of entry state
; unless an extra INC AUXR1 is added
;
00A2
;
AUXR1 QU 0A2H
0000 909000MOV DPTR,#SOURCE ; address of SOURCE
0003 05A2 INC AUXR1 ; switch data pointers
0005 90A000 MOV DPTR,#DEST ; address of DEST
0008 LOOP:
0008 05A2 INC AUXR1 ; switch data pointers
000A E0 MOVX A,@DPTR ; get a byte from SOURCE
000B A3 INC DPTR ;increment SOURCE address
000C 05A2 INC AUXR1 ; switch data pointers
000E F0 MOVX @DPTR,A ; write the byte to DEST
000F A3 INC DPTR ; increment DEST address
0010 70F6JNZ LOOP ; check for 0 terminator
0012 05A2 INC AUXR1 ; (optional) restore DPS
INC is a short (2 bytes) and fast (12 clocks) way to manipulate the DPS bit in the AUXR1
SFR. However, note that the INC instruction does not directly force the DPS bit to a par-
ticular state, but simply toggles it. In simple routines, such as the block move example,
only the fact that DPS is toggled in the proper sequence matters, not its actual value.
For example, the block move routine works the same whether DPS is '0' or '1' on entry.
Observe that without the last instruction (INC AUXR1), the routine will exit with DPS in
the opposite state.
23
4202D–SCR–06/05
Registers
Table 5. Auxiliary Register - AUXR (8Eh)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DPU
-
-
-
XRS0
EXTRAM
AO
Bit
Bit
Number Mnemonic Description
Disable weak Pull-up
7
6-3
2
DPU
-
0
1
weak pull-up is enabled
weak pull-up is disabled
Reserved
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
XRAM Size
XRS0
0
1
256 bytes (default)
512 bytes
EXTRAM bit
Cleared to access internal XRAM using MOVX @ Ri/ @ DPTR.
1
0
EXTRAM Set to access external memory.
Programmed by hardware after Power-up regarding Hardware Security Byte
(HSB), default setting , XRAM selected.
ALE Output bit
Cleared , ALE is emitted at a constant rate of 1/6 the oscillator frequency (or 1/3 if
X2 mode is used)(default).
AO
Set , ALE is active only when a MOVX or MOVC instruction is used.
Reset Value = 0XXX X000b
24
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 6. Auxiliary Register 1 AUXR1- (0A2h) for AT8xC5122
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
ENBOOT
-
GF3
0
-
DPS
Bit
Bit
Number Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7 - 6
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
Enable Boot ROM (CRAM / E2PROM version only)
Set this bit to map the Boot ROM from 8000h to FFFFh. If the PC increments
beyond 7FFFh address, the code is fetch from internal ROM
Clear this bit to disable Boot ROM. If the PC increments beyond 7FFFh address,
the code is fetch from external code memory (C51 standard roll over function)
5
ENBOOT
This bit is forced to 1 at reset
Reserved
4
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
3
2
GF3
0
This bit is a general-purpose user flag.
Always cleared.
Reserved
1
0
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Data Pointer Selection
DPS
Cleared to select DPTR0. Set to select DPTR1.
Reset Value = XX1X XX0X0b (Not bit addressable)
Table 7. Auxiliary Register 1 AUXR1- (0A2h) for AT83C5123
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
-
GF3
0
-
DPS
Bit
Bit
Number Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7 - 6
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
Reserved
5
4
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
Reserved
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
3
2
GF3
0
This bit is a general-purpose user flag.
Always cleared.
Reserved
1
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Data Pointer Selection
Cleared to select DPTR0.
Set to select DPTR1.
0
DPS
Reset Value = XXXX XX0X0b (Not bit addressable)
25
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 8. CRAM Configuration Register - RCON (D1h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
-
RPS
-
-
-
Bit
Number
Bit
Mnemonic
Description
Reserved
7 - 4
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
CRAM Memory Mapping Bit
Set to map the CRAM memory during MOVX instructions
Clear to map the XRAM memory during MOVX.
This bit has priority over the EXTRAM bit.
3
RPS
Reserved
2-0
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
Reset Value = XXXX 0XXXb
AT8xC5122’s CRAM and E2PROM Versions
The AT8xC5122’s CRAM and E2PROM versions implements :
- 32 KB of ROM mapped from 8000 to FFFF in which is embedded a bootloader for In-
System Programming feature
- 32 KB of CRAM (Code RAM) , a volatile program memory mapped from 0000 to 7FFF
In CRAM versions only :
- 512 bytes of E2PROM can be optionally implemented to store permanent data
In E2PROM version :
- 32KB of E2PROM are implemented to store permanent code
Warnings :
–
some bytes of user program memory space are reserved for bootloader
configuration. Depending on the configuration, up to 256 bytes of code may
be not available for the user code from 7F00h location. Refer to bootloader
datasheet for further details.
–
Port P3.7 may be used by the bootloader as a hardware condition at reset to
select the In-System Programming mode. Once the bootloader has started,
the P3.7 Port is no more used.
26
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
AT8xC5122 Microcontroller
FFFFh
P3.7
Bootloader
7FFFh
7F00h
7EFFh
Reserved
User code
0000h
When pin EA =1 and after the reset, the MCU begins the execution of the embedded
bootloader from location F800h of the ROM. The bootloader implements an In-System
Programming (ISP) mode which manages the transfer of the code in the volatile Pro-
gram Memory (CRAM).
For CRAM version, the code is supplied by the ATMEL’s FLexible In-system Program-
ming software (FLIP) through USB or UART interface
For E2PROM version, the code is supplied from the internal code E2PROM or by FLIP.
The state of pin P3.7 at reset determines the code source. If P3.7=1 (reset condition)
the source is the internal E2PROM and the transfer takes about 1.5 seconds. If P3.7=0
the source is FLIP and the transfer time depends mainly on external conditions not
related to bootloader.
Once the code is running in CRAM, the roll-over condition (code fetched beyond
address 7FFFh) depends on the state of ENBOOT bit of AUXR1 register (Table 6 on
page 25).
If ENBOOT=1 (reset condition) the MCU fetches the code from bootloader ROM. If
ENBOOT=0, the MCU fetches the code from the external Program Memory. In this last
case, PSEN is activated and Ports P0 and P2 are used to emit data and address
signals.
Warning : external Program Memory access is not allowed on Low Pin Count
Packages.
27
4202D–SCR–06/05
Using CRAM Memory
The CRAM is a read / write volatile memory that is mapped in the program memory
space. Then when the power is switched off the code is lost and needs to be reload at
each power up. In return, the CRAM enables a lot of flexibility in the code development
as it can be programmed indefinitely. The user code running in the CRAM can perform
read operations in CRAM itself by means of MOVC instructions like any C51 microcon-
troller does. Although the writing operations in CRAM are usually handled by the
bootloader, it is possible for the user code to handle its own writing operations in CRAM
as well. The user code must call API functions provided by the bootloader in the ROM
memory. Refer to bootloader datasheet for further details about the use of these API
functions. These API functions use a mechanism provided by the AT8xC5122 microcon-
troller. When the bit RPS is set in RCON register (Table 8 on page 26), the MOVX
intructions are configured to write in CRAM instead of XRAM memory. However, due to
C51 architecture, it is not possible for the user code to write directly in CRAM when it is
itself running in CRAM. This is why the API functions must be called in order to have the
code executing in ROM while the CRAM is written.
Figure 12. Read / Write Mechanisms in CRAM Memory
API functions
BOOTLOADER
RPS=1
MOVX
Writing operation
CRAM
User code
API Call
Read operation
MOVC
28
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 13. AT8xC5122’s CRAM and E2PROM Versions
(E2PROM version)
EA = 0
EA = 1
FFFF
ENBOOT=0
ENBOOT=1
32K
FFFF
FFFF
8000
INTERNAL
E2PROM
(Read/Write)
Reset@
<F800>
32K
32K
EXTERNAL
PROGRAM
MEMORY
INTERNAL
ROM
8000
(Read Only)
8000
EXTERNAL
PROGRAM
MEMORY
Roll-Over
PSEN
7FFF
PROGRAM
MEMORY
32K
INTERNAL
CRAM
(Read/Write)
Reset@
0000
<0000>
PSEN
Optional
(applicable only to CRAM version)
EXTRAM=1
EXTRAM=0
FFFF
01FF
512 Bytes
INTERNAL
E2PROM
EXTERNAL
XRAM
0000
On-Chip 256 bytes RAM
0200
Roll-Over
DATA MEMORY
(Read / Write)
Indirect
Direct
Addressing
Addressing
FF
80
FF
01FF
01FF
Upper
128 Bytes
RAM
SFR
On-chip
512 bytes
XRAM
Space
EXTERNAL
XRAM
80
7F
0000
0000
Lower
128 Bytes
RAM
00
RD WR
29
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122’s ROM
Version
The AT8xC5122’s ROM version implements :
- 32 K of ROM mapped from 0000h to 7FFFh in which is embedded the user code. The
ROM device is only factory programmable.
- 512 bytes of E2PROM can be optionally implemented to store permanent data. With
this option, the size of ROM is reduced to 30K.
After the reset, the MCU begins the execution of the user code from location 0000h of
the ROM.
Access to external Program Memory is not allowed.
Security Level
There are two security levels (applicable to High Pin Count packages only) :
Table 9. Security Levels Description
Security Level
Protection description
1
No protection lock enabled
MOVC instruction executed from external Program Memory is disabled when fetching
code bytes from internal Program Memory
EA is sampled and latched on reset.
External code execution is enabled.
2
The security level 2 can be used to protect the user code from piracy. This option is con-
figured at factory and must be requested by the customer at order time.
30
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 14. AT8xC5122’s ROM Version
EA=1
EA=0
FFFF
8000
EXTERNAL
Roll-Over
PROGRAM MEMORY
(Read only)
7FFF
0000
INTERNAL
EXTERNAL
32K ROM
RESET@
<0000>
PSEN
Optional
01FF
EXTRAM=1
EXTRAM=0
FFFF
0200
512 Bytes
INTERNAL
E2PROM
EXTERNAL
XRAM
0000
On-Chip 256 bytes RAM
DATA MEMORY
(Read / Write)
Roll-Over
Indirect
Direct
Addressing
Addressing
FF
80
FF
01FF
0000
01FF
Upper
128 Bytes
RAM
SFR
On-chip
512 bytes
XRAM
Space
EXTERNAL
XRAM
80
7F
0000
Lower
128 Bytes
RAM
00
RD WR
31
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT83C5123 Version
The AT83C5123 device is a low pin count version of the AT8xC5122.
The ROM version implements :
- 30 KB of ROM mapped from 0000 to 77FF in which is embedded the user code. The
ROM device is only factory programmable.
- 512 bytes of E2PROM can be optionally implemented to store permanent data
Figure 15. AT83C5123’s Device
7FFF
INTERNAL
30K ROM
PROGRAM MEMORY
(Read only)
RESET@
<0000>
OPTIONAL
01FF
On-Chip 256 bytes RAM
Indirect
Direct
512 Bytes
Addressing
Addressing
INTERNAL
E2PROM
FF
80
FF
Upper
128 Bytes
RAM
SFR
DATA MEMORY
(Read / Write)
0000
01FF
Space
80
7F
Lower
On-chip
512 bytes
XRAM
128 Bytes
RAM
00
0000
32
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Special Function
Registers (SFR’s)
Introduction
The Special Function Registers (SFRs) of the AT8xC5122/23 can be ranked into the fol-
lowing categories:
•
•
C51 Core Registers: ACC, B, DPH, DPL, PSW, SP
System Configuration Registers: PCON, CKRL, CKCON0, CKCON1, CKSEL,
PLLCON, PLLDIV, AUXR, AUXR1, RCON
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
I/O Port Registers: P0, P1, P2, P3, P4, P5, PMOD1, PMOD2
Timer Registers: TCON, TH0, TH1, TMOD, TL0, TL1
Watchdog (WD) Registers: WDTRST, WDTPRG
Serial I/O Port Registers: SADDR, SADEN, SBUF, SCON
Baud Rate Generator (BRG) Registers: BRL, BDRCON
System Interrupt Registers: IE0, IPL0, IPH0, IE1, IPL1, IPH1
Smart Card Interface (SCI) Registers: SCSR, SCCON/SCETU0, SCISR/SCETU1,
SCIER/SCIIR, SCIBUF, SCGT0/SCWT0, SCGT1/SCWT1, SCICR/SCWT2, SCICLK
•
•
•
•
DC/DC Converter Registers: DCCKPS
Keyboard Interface Registers: KBE, KBF, KBLS
Serial Port Interface (SPI) Registers: SPCON, SPSTA, SPDAT
Universal Serial Bus (USB) Registers:USBCON, USBADDR, USBINT, USBIEN,
UEPNUM, UEPCONX, UEPSTAX, UEPRST, UEPINT, UEPIEN, UEPDATX,
UBYCTX, UFNUML, UFNUMH
•
LED Controller Registers: LEDCON0, LEDCON1
33
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122 Version
Bit
addressable
Not bit addressable
0/8
1/9
2/A
3/B
4/C
5/D
6/E
7/F
UEPINT
F8h
0000 0000
LEDCON0
0000 0000
B
F0h
0000 0000
P5
E8h
1111 1111
LEDCON1
XX00 0000
ACC
E0h
UBYCTX
0000 0000
0000 0000
D8h
RCON
XXXX 0XXX
PSW
D0h
UEPCONX
1000 0000
UEPRST
0000 0000
0000 0000
UEPSTAX
0000 0000
UEPDATX
0000 0000
C8h
SCICLK (1)
0X10 1111
S 1
P4
1111 1111
SPCON
0001 0100
SPSTA
0000 0000
SPDAT
1111 1111
C
UEPIEN
0000 0000
USBADDR
1000 0000
UEPNUM
0000 0000
C0h
R
S 0
SCWT3 (1)
0000 0000
IPL0
X000 000
SADEN
0000 0000
DCCKPS
0000 0000
UFNUML
0000 0000
UFNUMH
0000 0000
USBCON
0000 0000
USBINT
0000 0000
USBIEN
0000 0000
B8h
SCICR (1)
0000 0000
SCGT0 (1)
0000 1100
SCGT1(1)
S 1
C
XXXX XXX0
P3
1111 1111
IPL1
00XX 00X0
IPH1
00XX 00X0
IPH0
X000 0000
IEN1
B0h
A8h
R
XXXX X000
SCWT0(1)
1000 0000
SCWT1 (1)
0010 0101
SCWT2 (1)
0000 0000
S 0
(1)
SCETU0 (1)
0111 0100
SCETU1 (1)
XXXX X001
SCIER
S 1
C
0X00 0000
IEN0
0000 0000
SADDR
0000 0000
SCSR
X000 1000
SCIBUF
XXXX XXXX
R
SCCON (1)
0000 0000
SCISR (1)
10X0 0000
SCIIR (1)
0X00 0000
S 0
P2
1111 1111
ISEL
0000 0100
AUXR1
XX1X 0XX0
WDTRST
XXXX XXXX
WDTPRG
XXXX X000
PLLCON
XXXX X000
PLLDIV
0000 0000
A0h
SCON
0000 0000
SBUF
XXXX XXXX
BRL
0000 0000
BDRCON
XXX0 0000
KBLS
0000 0000
KBE
0000 0000
KBF
0000 0000
98h
90h
88h
80h
PMOD0(2)
0000 0000
P1
1111 1111
CKRL
XXXX 1111
TCON
0000 0000
TMOD
0000 0000
TL0
0000 0000
TL1
0000 0000
TH0
0000 0000
TH1
0000 0000
CKCON0
X0X0 X000
AUXR
0XXX X000
P0
1111 1111
PMOD1
0000 0000
CKSEL
XXXX XXX0
PCON
00X1 0000
SP
0000 0111
DPL
0000 0000
DPH
0000 0000
Notes: 1. Mapping is done using SCRS bit in SCSR register.
2. Grey areas : do not write in.
34
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
AT83C5123 Version
Bit
addressable
Not bit addressable
4/C
0/8
1/9
2/A
3/B
5/D
6/E
7/F
UEPINT
F8h
0000 0000
LEDCON0
0000 0000
B
F0h
0000 0000
P5
E8h
XXXX XXX1
ACC
E0h
UBYCTX
0000 0000
0000 0000
D8h
PSW
D0h
UEPCONX
1000 0000
UEPRST
0000 0000
0000 0000
UEPSTAX
0000 0000
UEPDATX
0000 0000
C8h
SCICLK (1)
0X10 1111
S
C
R
S
1
0
P4
UEPIEN
0000 0000
USBADDR
1000 0000
UEPNUM
0000 0000
C0h
SCWT3 (1)
0000 0000
11XX XXXX
IPL0
X000 000
SADEN
0000 0000
DCCKPS
0000 0000
UFNUML
0000 0000
UFNUMH
0000 0000
USBCON
0000 0000
USBINT
0000 0000
USBIEN
0000 0000
B8h
SCICR (1)
0000 0000
SCGT0 (1)
0000 1100
SCGT1(1)
S
C
R
S
1
0
1
0
XXXX XXX0
P3
1111 1111
IPL1
X0XX 0XXX
IPH1
X0XX 0XXX
IPH0
X000 0000
IEN1
B0h
A8h
X0XX 0XXX
SCWT0(1)
1000 0000
SCWT1 (1)
0010 0101
SCWT2 (1)
0000 0000
(1)
SCETU0 (1)
0111 0100
SCETU1 (1)
XXXX X001
SCIER
S
C
R
S
0X00 0000
IEN0
0000 0000
SADDR
0000 0000
SCSR
X000 1000
CKCON1
XXXX XXX0
SCIBUF
XXXX XXXX
SCCON (1)
0000 0000
SCISR (1)
10X0 0000
SCIIR (1)
0X00 0000
ISEL
0000 0100
AUXR1
XXXX 0XX0
WDTRST
XXXX XXXX
WDTPRG
XXXX X000
PLLCON
XXXX X000
PLLDIV
0000 0000
A0h
SCON
0000 0000
SBUF
XXXX XXXX
BRL
0000 0000
BDRCON
XXX0 0000
98h
90h
88h
80h
P1
1111 1111
PMOD0
00XX 0XXX
CKRL
XXXX 1111
TCON
0000 0000
TMOD
0000 0000
TL0
0000 0000
TL1
0000 0000
TH0
0000 0000
TH1
0000 0000
CKCON0
X0X0 X000
AUXR
0XXX X000
PMOD1
CKSEL
PCON
SP
0000 0111
DPL
0000 0000
DPH
0000 0000
XXXX 00XX
XXXX XXX0
00X1 0000
Notes: 1. Mapping is done using SCRS bit in SCSR register.
2. Grey areas : do not write in.
35
4202D–SCR–06/05
SFR’s Description
Table 10. C51 Core SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ACC
B
E0h Accumulator
F0h B Register
ACC
B
PSW
SP
D0h Program Status Word
81h Stack Pointer
CY
AC
F0
RS1
RS0
OV
F1
P
SP
Data Pointer Low byte (LSB
DPL
DPH
82h
DPL
of DPTR)
Data Pointer High byte
83h
DPH
(MSB of DPTR)
Table 11. Clock SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PCON
87h Power Controller
SMOD1
SMOD0
WDX2
POF
SIX2
GF1
GF0
T1X2
PD
IDL
CKCON0
CKCON1
CKSEL
CKRL
8Fh Clock Controller 0
AFh Clock Controller 1
85h Clock Selection
T0X2
X2
SPIX2
CKS
97h Clock Reload Register
A3h PLL Controller Register
A4h PLL Divider register
8Eh Auxiliary Register 0
A2h Auxiliary Register 1
CKREL 3-0
PLLCON
PLLDIV
AUXR
EXT48
PLLEN
PLOCK
R3-0
N3-0
DPU
XRS0
EXTRAM
A0
AUXR1
ENBOOT(1)
GF3
RPS
DPS
CRAM memory
D1h
RCON (1)
Configuration
Note:
1. Only for AT8xC5122
Table 12. I/O Port SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P0(1)
80h Port 0
P0
P1
90h Port 1
P1
P2
P3
P4
P2(1)
P3
A0h Port 2
B0h Port 3
P4(1)
P5
C0h Port 4
E8h Port 5
P5 (only P5.0 for AT8xC5122)
PMOD0
PMOD1
91h Port Mode Register 0
84h Port Mode Register 1
P3C1
P3C0
P2C1(1)
P2C0(1)
CPRESRES
P5LC1
-
P0C1(1)
P4C1(1)
P0C0(1)
P4C0(1)
P5HC1(1)
P5HC0(1)
P5MC1(1)
P5MC0(1)
P5LC0
Note:
1. Only for AT8xC5122
36
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 13. Timers SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TH0
TL0
TH1
TL1
8Ch Timer/Counter 0 High byte
TH0
TL0
TH1
TL1
8Ah Timer/Counter 0 Low byte
8Dh Timer/Counter 1 High byte
8Bh Timer/Counter 1 Low byte
Timer/Counter 0 and 1
TCON
TMOD
88h
TF1
TR1
TF0
M11
TR0
M01
IE1
IT1
IE0
IT0
control
Timer/Counter 0 and 1
Modes
89h
GATE1
C/T1#
GATE0
C/T0#
M10
M00
Table 14. Watchdog SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WDTRST
WDTPRG
A6h Watchdog Timer Reset
A7h Watchdog Timer Program
WDTRST
S2-0
Table 15. Serial I/O Ports SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SCON
SBUF
98h Serial Control
FE/SM0
SM1
SM2
REN
TB8
RB8
TI
RI
99h Serial Data Buffer
B9h Slave Address Mask
A9h Slave Address
SBUF
SADEN
SADDR
SADEN
SADDR
Table 16. Baud Rate Generator SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
5
5
4
3
2
1
0
BRL
9Ah Baud Rate Reload
9Bh Baud Rate Control
BRL
BDRCON
BRR
TBCK
RBCK
SPD
M0SRC
Table 17. Interrupt SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
4
3
2
1
0
IEN0
IEN1
A8h Interrupt Enable Control 0
EA
ES
ET1
ESCI
EX1
ET0
EX0
B1h Interrupt Enable Control 1
EUSB
ESPI(1)
EKB(1)
Interrupt Priority Control
Low 0
IPL0
B8h
PSL
PT1L
PX1L
PT0L
PX0L
37
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 17. Interrupt SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Interrupt Priority Control
High 0
IPH0
IPL1
B7h
B2h
B3h
PSH
PT1H
PX1H
PT0H
PX0H
Interrupt Priority Control
Low 1
PUSBL
PUSBH
PSCIL
PSPIL(1)
PKBL(1)
Interrupt Priority Control
High 1
IPH1
ISEL
PSCIH
OELEV
PSPIH(1)
OEEN
PKBH(1)
RXEN
A1h Interrupt Enable Register
CPLEV
PRESIT
RXIT
PRESEN
Note:
1. Only for AT8xC5122
Table 18. SCIB SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Smart Card Transmit Guard
Time Register 0
SCGT0
SCGT1
SCWT0
SCWT1
SCWT2
SCWT3
SCICR
SCCON
B4h
B5h
B4h
B5h
B6h
C1h
B6h
ACh
GT7 - 0
Smart Card Transmit Guard
Time Register 1
GT8
Smart Card Character/ Block
Waiting Time Register 0
WT7 - 0
WT15-8
Smart Card Character/ Block
Waiting Time Register 1
Smart Card Character/ Block
Waiting Time Register 2
WT23-16
WT31-24
Smart Card Character/ Block
Waiting Time Register 3
Smart Card Interface Control
Register
RESET
CLK
CARDDET
CARDIN
VCARD1-0
UART
WTEN
CREP
CONV
Smart Card Interface
Contacts Register
CARDC8
CARDC4
CARDIO CARDCLK CARDRST CARDVCC
SCETU0
SCETU1
ACh Smart Card ETU Register 0
ADh Smart Card ETU Register 1
ETU7 - 0
COMP
ETU10-8
SCRC
Smart Card UART Interface
ADh
ICARDOVF
SCISR
SCIIR
SCTBE
VCARDOK SCWTO
SCTC
SCTI
SCPE
SCPI
Status Register (Read only)
Smart Card UART Interrupt
AEh Identification Register (Read
only)
ICARDERR VCARDERR
SCTBI
SCWTI
SCRI
Smart Card UART Interrupt
EVCARDER
CREPSEL
SCIER
SCSR
AEh
ESCTBI
ICARDER
ESCWTI
ESCTI
ESCRI
ESCPI
SCRS
Enable Register
Smart Card Selection
Register
ABh
BGTEN
ALTKPS1-0
SCCLK1
Can store a new byte to be transmitted on the I/O pin when SCTBE is set. Bit ordering on the I/O pin
depends on the convention
Provides the byte received from the I/O pin when SCRI is set. Bit ordering on the I/O pin depends on
the convention.
SCIBUF
AAh Smart Card Buffer Register
38
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 18. SCIB SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
5
5
4
4
3
3
2
1
0
Smart Card Frequency
Prescaler Register
SCICLK
C1h
XTSCS(1)
SCICLK5-0
Note:
1. Only for AT8xC5122
Table 19. DC/DC SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
2
1
0
DC/DC Converter Reload
Register
DCCKPS
BFh
MODE
OVFADJ
BOOST[1-0]
DCCKPS3-0
Table 20. Keyboard SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
KBF(1)
9Eh Keyboard Flag Register
KBE7 - 0
KBF7 - 0
Keyboard Input Enable
Register
KBE(1)
9Dh
9Ch
Keyboard Level Selector
Register
KBLS(1)
KBLS7 - 0
Note:
1. Only for AT8xC5122
Table 21. SPI SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SPCON(1)
SPSTA(1)
SPDAT(1)
C3h Serial Peripheral Control
SPR2
SPEN
SSDIS
MSTR
CPOL
CPHA
SPR1
SPR0
Serial Peripheral Status-
C4h
SPIF
WCOL
MODF
Control
C5h Serial Peripheral Data
R7 - 0
Notes: 1. Only for AT8xC5122
Table 22. USB SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
USBCON
USBADDR
USBINT
BCh USB Global Control
USBE
FEN
SUSPCLK SDRMWUP DETACH
UPRSM
UADD6-0
SOFINT
RMWUPE
CONFG
FADDEN
C6h USB Address
BDh USB Global Interrupt
WUPCPU
EORINT
SPINT
USB Global Interrupt
Enable
USBIEN
BEh
EWUPCPU EEORINT ESOFINT
ESPINT
UEPNUM
UEPCONX
UEPSTAX
UEPRST
UEPINT
C7h USB Endpoint Number
D4h USB Endpoint X Control
CEh USB Endpoint X Status
D5h USB Endpoint Reset
F8h USB Endpoint Interrupt
EPNUM3-0
EPEN
DIR
NAKIEN
NAKOUT
NAKIN
TXRDY
EP4RST
EP4INT
DTGL
EPDIR
EPTYPE1 EPTYPE0
RXOUTB1 STALLRQ
STL/CRC RXSETUP RXOUTB0
TXCMP
EP0RST
EP0INT
EP6RST
EP6INT
EP5RST
EP5INT
EP3RST
EP3INT
EP2RST
EP2INT
EP1RST
EP1INT
39
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 22. USB SFRs
Mnemonic Add Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
USB Endpoint Interrupt
Enable
UEPIEN
C2h
EP6INTE
EP5INTE
EP4INTE
EP3INTE
EP2INTE
EP1INTE
EP0INTE
UEPDATX
UBYCTX
CFh USB Endpoint X Fifo Data
FDAT7 - 0
USB Byte Counter Low
E2h
BYCT6-0
(EPX)
UFNUML
UFNUMH
BAh USB Frame Number Low
BBh USB Frame Number High
FNUM7 - 0
CRCOK
CRCERR
FNUM10-8
Table 23. LED SFRs
Mnemonic
LEDCON0
LEDCON1(1)
Add Name
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
F1h LED Control 0
E1h LED Control 1
LED3
LED2
LED6
LED1
LED5
LED0
LED4
Note:
1. Only for AT8xC5122
40
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Clock Controller
The clock controller is based on an on-chip oscillator feeding an on-chip Phase Lock
Loop (PLL). All the internal clocks to the CPU core and peripherals are generated by this
controller.
On-Chip Oscillator
The on-chip oscillator is composed of a single-stage inverter and a parallel feedback
resistor. The XTAL1 and XTAL2 pins are respectively the input and the output of the
inverter, which can be configured with off-chip components as a Pierce oscillator (see
Figure 16).
The on-chip oscillator has been designed and optimized to work with an external 8 MHz
crystal and very few load capacitance. Then external load capacitors are not needed
given that :
–
the internal capacitance of the microcontroller and the stray capacitance of
circuit board are enough to ensure a stable oscillation
–
a very high accuracy on the oscillation frequency is not needed
The circuit works on its fundamental frequency at 8 MHz.
Figure 16. Oscillator Schematic
Microcontroller
To internal
clock circuitry
Feedback
Resistor
XTAL2
C2
XTAL1
8 MHz
C1
GND
GND
C1 and C2 represents the internal capacitance of the microcontroller and the stray
capacitance of the circuit board. It is recommended to implement the crystal as close as
possible from the microcontroller package.
Quartz Specification
The equivalent circuit of a crystal is represented on the figure below :
L1
C1
R1
C0
The Equivalent Serial Resistance R1 must be lower than 100 Ohm.
41
4202D–SCR–06/05
Phase Lock Loop (PLL)
PLL Description
The AT8xC5122/23’s PLL is used to generate internal high frequency clock synchro-
nized with an external low-frequency. Figure 17 shows the internal structure of the PLL.
The PFLD block is the Phase Frequency Comparator and Lock Detector. This block
makes the comparison between the reference clock coming from the N divider and the
reverse clock coming from the R divider and generates some pulses on the Up or Down
signal depending on the edge position of the reverse clock. The PLLEN bit in PLLCON
register is used to enable the clock generation. When the PLL is locked, the bit PLOCK
in PLLCON register is set.
The CHP block is the Charge Pump that generates the voltage reference for the VCO by
injecting or extracting charges from the external filter connected on PLLF pin (see
Figure 18). Value of the filter components are detailed in the Section “DC
Characteristics”.
The VCO block is the Voltage Controlled Oscillator controlled by the voltage VREF pro-
duced by the charge pump. It generates a square wave signal: the PLL clock. The
CK_PLL frequency is defined by the follwing formula:
F
CK_PLL = FCK_XTAL1 * (R+1) / (N+1)
Figure 17. PLL Block Diagram and Symbol
PLLF
CHP
PLLCON.1
PLLEN
N Divider
N3:0
Up
VREF
CK_XTAL1
PFLD
VCO
CK_PLL
Down
PLOCK
R divider
R3:0
PLLCON.0
Figure 18. PLL Filter Value
PLLF
1,8
KΩ
33 pF
150 pF
VSS
VSS
PLL Programming
The PLL must be programmed to work at 96 MHz frequency by means of PLLCON and
PLLDIV registers. As soon as the PLL is enabled, the firmware must wait for the lock bit
status to ensure that the PLL is ready.
42
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 19. PLL Programming Flow
PLL
Programming
Configure Dividers
N3:0= xxxxb
R3:0= xxxxb
Enable PLL
PLLEN= 1
PLL Locked?
PLOCK= 1?
Clock Tree Architecture
The clock controller outputs several different clocks as shown in Figure 20:
•
•
a clock for the CPU core
a clock for the peripherals which is used to generate the timers, watchdog, SPI,
UART, and ports sampling clocks. This divided clock will be used to generate the
alternate card clock.
•
•
•
a clock for the USB
a clock for the SCIB controller
a clock for the DC/DC converter
These clocks are enabled or not depending on the power reduction mode as detailed in
Section “Power Management”, page 180.
These clocks are generated using four presacalers defined in the table below:
Prescaler
PR1
Register
CKRL
Reload Factor
CKRL[0:3]
Function
CPU & Peripheral clocks
Smart card
PR2
SCICLK
SCSR
SCICLK[0:5]
ALTKPS[0:1]
DCCKPS[3:0]
PR3
Alternate card
DC/DC
PR4
DCCKPS
43
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 20. Clock Tree Diagram
DC/DC
CK_DCDC
PR4
DCCKPS[3:0]
Converter
CKCON0.X or
CKCON1.0
PeriphX2
CKCON0.0
Peripherals
X2
CK_T0
CK_T1
CK_SI
1
0
1
0
CK_PERIPH
1/2
CK_WD
CK_SPI
PERIPH = T0, T1, SI, WD or SPI
CK_XTAL1
CK_PLL
0
1
PR1
CKRL[3:0]
0
1
CK_CPU
CK_IDLE
CPU
CKS
IDL
CKSEL.0
X2
PCON.0
CKCON0.0
CK_XTAL1
Alternate
PLL
XTAL1
PR3
SCSR[3:2]
CK_PLL
Card
96 MHz
XTAL2
PLLEN
CK_IDLE
CK_PLL
PLLCON.1
0
SCIB
USB
<48
=48
PR2
SCICLK[5:0]
CK_ISO
CK_XTAL1
1
PD
PCON.1
SCICLK[5:0]
XTSCS
SCICLK.7
EXT48
PLLCON.2
CK_IDLE
CK_USB
1/2
0
1
CK_XTAL1
CPU and Peripheral Clocks
Two clocks sources are available for CPU and peripherals:
–
–
on-chip oscillator
a derivative of the PLL clock.
These clock sources are configured by the PR1 prescaler to generate the CPU core
CK_CPU and the peripheral clocks:
–
–
–
–
–
–
CK_IDLE for alternate card and peripherals registers access
CK_T0 for Timer 0
CK_T1 for Timer 1
CK_SI for the UART
CK_WD for the Watchdog Timer
CK_SPI for SPI
44
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
The CPU and peripherals clocks frequencies are defined in the table below.
CKS
X2
0
FCK_IDLE
0
0
1
1
FCK_XTAL1/(2*(16-CKRL))
FCK_XTAL1
1
0
FCK_PLL/(2*(16-CKRL))
Not allowed
1
X1 and X2 Modes
Use of on-chip oscillator
When the CPU and Peripherals clocks are fed by the on-chip oscillator, the CPU and
Peripherals can be configured independently in X1 or X2 mode depending on the fre-
quencies wanted by the user. There is however one exception : the periperals can be
configured in X2 mode while the CPU remains in X1 mode. This exception is handled by
the hardware and the user does not need to take care of.
Table 1. X1 and X2 Mode Selection
CPU
Peripherals
X1 mode
X2 mode
Status
Frequenci
Allowed
X1 mode
X1 mode
(default configuration at reset)
F
CK_IDLE = FCK_PERIPH
Not Allowed by the hardware
Allowed
Once the CPU is switched to X2
mode, the user is free to switch
any of the peripherals to X1
mode
X2 mode
X2 mode
X1 mode
X2 mode
FCK_IDLE = 2*FCK_PERIPH
Allowed
FCK_IDLE = FCK_PERIPH
Default configuration when CPU
is switched to X2 mode
The X1 or X2 modes can be individually selected for the CPU and each peripheral by
means of CKCON0 and CKCON1 registers. At reset, the CPU and Peripherals are set
all by default to X1 mode. In this mode, changing any peripheral to X2 mode has no
effect. When X2 bit is set in CKCON0 register, CPU and All peripherals are automati-
cally switched to X2 mode. It is then possible for the user to individually switch any
peripheral back to X1 mode.
In X1 mode (X2 bit cleared in CKCON0 regsiter), the PR1 prescaler is active while it is
bypassed in X2 mode (X2 bit set in CKCON0 register).
The X1 mode is true only when the prescaler PR1 is set to 1/2 (default condition at
reset).
45
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 21. X1 mode
PR1 prescaler
1/2
Crystal
8 MHz
CPU frequency
4 MHz
Peripheral frequency
4 MHz
When the X1 mode is selected, the CPU and Peripherals work at 8Mhz / X1
Figure 22. X2 mode
CPU frequency (X2 Mode)
Crystal
8 MHz
8 MHz
Peripheral frequency (X2 mode)
8 MHz
Peripheral frequency (X1 mode)
4 MHz
Internal Prescaler
1/2
When the X2 mode is selected, the CPU works at 8 MHz / X2. The Peripherals can work
at 8 MHz / X2 or 8 MHz / X1.
When the PR1 prescaler is different from 1/2, the usual X1 mode can not be defined. In
this case, it is necessary to define a X1 or X2 equivalent mode from equivalent clock
circuits.
Example : PR1=1/8, X2=0.
In this configuration, the CPU works at 1 MHz. This frequency could also be obtained by
an equivalent clock circuit where the on-chip oscillator would run at 2 MHz in X1 mode
or at 1 MHz in X2 mode. So we can say that the CPU works at 2 MHz / X1 or 1MHz / X2.
As the X2 bit is cleared in CKCON0 register, we have FCK_IDLE = FCK_PERIPH
.
46
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
PR1 Prescaler
1/8
CPU frequency
1 MHz
Crystal
8 MHz
PERIPH frequency
1 MHz
(Equivalent to)
X1 mode selected
External Clock
2 MHz
CPU frequency
1 MHz
1/2
PERIPH frequency
1 MHz
(Equivalent to)
CPU frequency
1 MHz
External Clock
1 MHz
X2 mode selected
PERIPH frequency
1 MHz
Use of PLL Clock
When the CPU clock is fed by the PLL, the X2 mode is forbidden. The bit X2 must
always remain cleared in CKCON0 register. As the PR1 prescaler is always different
from 1/2, the usual X1 mode can not be defined. So it is necessary to define an equiva-
lent X1 or X2 mode from equivalent clock circuits, as in previous section.
Example: PR1=1/4, PLL feeds the CPU. The CPU works in this case at 24 MHz. This
frequency could also be obtained by an equivalent clock circuit where the on-chip oscil-
lator would run at 48 MHz in X1 mode or at 24 Mhz in X2 mode. So we can say that in
this configuration, the CPU works at 48 MHz / X1 or 24 MHz / X2 (See figures below).
As the X2 bit is cleared in CKCON0 register, we have always FCK_IDLE = FCK_PERIPH
.
47
4202D–SCR–06/05
CPU frequency
24 MHz
Prescaler
1/4
PLL
96 MHz
PERIPH frequency
24 MHz
(Equivalent to)
X1 mode selected
1/2
External Clock
48 MHz
CPU frequency
24 MHz
PERIPH frequency
24 MHz
(Equivalent to)
CPU frequency
24 MHz
External Clock
24 MHz
X2 mode selected
PERIPH frequency
24 MHz
SCIB Clock
The Smart Card Interface Block (SCIB) uses two clocks :
–
The first one, CK_IDLE, is the peripheral clock used for the interface with the
microcontroller.
–
The second one, CK_ISO, is independant from the CPU clock and is
generated from the PLL or XTAL1 output.
PR2, a 6-bit prescaler, will be used to generate:
12/9.6/8/6.85/6/5.33/4.8/4.36/ ..../1MHz frequencies.
SCIB clock frequency must be lower than CPU clock frequency.
During SCIB Reset, the CK_ISO input must be in the range 1 - 5 MHz according to ISO
7816. The SCIB clocks frequency is defined in Figure 42 on page 74 and Table 42 on
page 74.
Two conditions must be met for a correct use of the SCIB:
•
•
CK_CPU > 4/3 * CK_ISO and
CK_CPU < 6 * CK_ISO.
48
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
If the CK_CPU <= 4/3 * CK_ISO, the SCIB doesn’t work.
If the CK_CPU >= 6* CK_ISO, the programmer must take care in three cases:
•
Read (or write) operation on a SCIB register followed immediatly with an other Read
(or write) operation on the same register.
•
Read (or write) operation on a SCIB register followed immediatly with an other Read
(or write) operation on a linked register. The list of linked registers is in the table
below.
Linked registers
Write in SCICR and after read of SCETU0-1
Write in SCIBUF and after read of SCISR
•
Write operation on a register of the list below followed immediatly with a read
operation on a SCIB register.
Wait after Write operation on this registers
SCICR, SCIER, SCETU0-1,SCGT0-1,
SCWT0-3,SCCON
To avoid any trouble, a delay must be added between the two accesses on the SCIB
register. The SCIB must complete the first read (or write) operation before to receive the
second. A solution is to add NOP (no operation) instructions. The number of NOP to add
depends of the rate between CK_CPU and CK_ISO (see table below).
Number of
Min CLK_CPU
Max CLK_CPU
CPU cycles to add
6 ( example1 NOP)
12 ( example 2 NOP)
CLK_CPU >= 6 * CLK_ISO
CLK_CPU >= 12* CLK_ISO
CLK_CPU <= 12 * CLK_ISO
CLK_CPU <= 16 * CLK_ISO
Alternate Card Clock
The alternate Card uses the peripheral clock divided by the PR3 prescaler. (1; 1/2; 1/4;
1/8 division ratio). See Section "Alternate Card", page 78 for the definition of the alter-
nate clock.
DC/DC Converter Clock
The DC/DC block needs a clock with a 50% duty cycle. The frequency must also be
included in the range 3.68 MHz and 6 MHz. The PR4 prescaler is used to configure the
DC/DC frequency.
XTAL1 (MHz)
DCCKPS3:0 value
Prescaler Factor
DC/DC converter CLK (MHz)
8
0
2
4
49
4202D–SCR–06/05
USB Interface Clock
The USB Interface uses two clocks :
–
The first one is the CPU clock used for the interface with the microcontroller,
CK_IDLE.
–
The second one is the CK_USB supplied from the PLL through a divider by
2.
Registers
Table 24. Clock Selection Register - CKSEL (S:85h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
CKS
Bit Number Bit Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7:1
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not set this bit.
CPU Oscillator Select Bit
Set this bit to connect CPU and Peripherals to PLL output.
0
CKS
Clear this to to connect CPU and Peripherals to XTAL1 clock input.
Reset Value = XXXX XXX0b
Table 25. Clock Reload Register - CKRL (S:97h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
-
CKRL3
CKRL2
CKRL1
CKRL0
Bit Number Bit Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7 - 4
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not set this bit.
Clock Reload register
Prescaler1 value
3:0
CKRL3:0
Fck_cpu =[ 1 / 2*(16-CKRL)] * Fck_XTAL1
Reset Value = XXXX 1111b
50
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 26. Clock Configuration Register 0 - CKCON0 (S:8Fh)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
WDX2
-
SIX2
-
T1X2
T0X2
X2
Bit Number Bit Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7
6
5
4
3
2
-
WDX2
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not set this bit.
Watchdog clock
This control bit is validated when the CPU clock X2 is set; when X2 is low,
this bit has no effect.
Cleared to bypass the PR1 prescaler.
Set to select the PR1 output for this peripheral.
Reserved
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not set this bit.
Enhanced UART clock (Mode 0 and 2)
This control bit is validated when the CPU clock X2 is set; when X2 is low,
this bit has no effect.
Cleared to bypass the PR1 prescaler.
Set to select the PR1 output for this peripheral.
SIX2
-
Reserved
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not set this bit.
Timer 1 clock
This control bit is validated when the CPU clock X2 is set; when X2 is low,
this bit has no effect.
Cleared to bypass the PR1 prescaler.
T1X2
Set to select the PR1 output for this peripheral.
Timer 0 clock
This control bit is validated when the CPU clock X2 is set; when X2 is low,
this bit has no effect.
1
0
T0X2
X2
Cleared to bypass the PR1 prescaler.
Set to select the PR1 output for this peripheral.
System clock Control bit
Cleared to select the PR1 output for CPU and all the peripherals .
Set to bypass the PR1 prescaler and to enable the individual peripherals ‘X2’
bits.
Reset Value = X0X0 X000b
51
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 27. Clock Configuration Register 1 - CKCON1 (S:AFh) only for AT8xC5122
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
SPIX2
Bit Number Bit Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7 - 4
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not set this bit.
Reserved
3
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not set this bit.
SPI clock
This control bit is validated when the CPU clock X2 is set. When X2 is low,
this bit has no effect.
0
SPIX2
Cleared to bypass the PR1 prescaler.
Set to select the PR1 output for this peripheral.
Reset Value = XXXX XXX0b
Table 28. PLL Control Register - PLLCON (S:A3h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
-
-
EXT48
PLLEN
PLOCK
Bit Number Bit Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7 - 3
-
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not set this bits.
External 48 MHz Enable Bit
Set this bit to select XTAL1 as USB clock.
Clear this bit to select PLL as USB clock.
SCIB clock is controlled by EXT48 bit and XTSCS bit.
2
EXT48
PLL Enable bit
Set to enable the PLL.
Clear to disable the PLL.
1
0
PLLEN
PLOCK
PLL Lock Indicator
Set by hardware when PLL is locked
Clear by hardware when PLL is unlocked
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
Table 29. PLL Divider Register - PLLDIV (S:A4h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R3
R2
R1
R0
N3
N2
N1
N0
Bit Number Bit Mnemonic Description
7 - 4
3 - 0
R3:0
N3:0
PLL R Divider Bits
PLL N Divider Bits
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
52
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
I/O Port Definition
Ports vs Packages
Table 30. I/O Number vs Packages
P0
P1
P2
8
P3
8
P4
6
P5
8
Total
46
VQFP64
QFN64
8
8
VQFP32
QFN32
-
-
8
6
-
-
8
6
-
-
1
1
17
13
PLCC28
Port 0
Port 0 has the following functions:
–
–
Default function: Port 0 is an 8-bit I/O port.
Alternate function: Port 0 is also the multiplexed low-order address and data
bus during accesses to external Program and Data Memory. In this
application, it uses strong internal pull-ups when emitting 1’s and it can drive
CMOS inputs without external pull-ups.
Port 0 has the following configurations:
–
Default configuration: open drain bi-directional I/O port. Port 0 pins that have
1’s written to them float, and in this state they can be used as high-
impedance inputs.
–
–
Configuration 2: Low speed output, “KB_OUT”
Configuration 3: Push-pull output
53
4202D–SCR–06/05
Port 1
Port 1 has the following functions:
–
Default function : Only Port 1.2, P1.6 and P1.7 are standard I/O’s; the other
ports can be activated only with the SCIB function.
–
Alternate function and configuration: see Table 31.
Table 31. Port 1 Description.
Alternate Function
Configuration
Mode
Port
Signal
Description
Comments
Low level at reset.
Smart card interface function
Card I/O
Quasi-bidirectional port supplied by
DC/DC converter
CIO
Caution : if DPU bit is set in AUXR register, the
weak-pull of the port is disabled
Low level at reset
Smart card interface function
Card contact 8
Quasi-bidirectional port supplied by
DC/DC converter
CC8
Caution : if DPU bit is set in AUXR register, the
weak-pull of the port is disabled
Weak & medium pull-up’s can be disconnected
by CPRESRES bit in PMOD0 regsiter
High Level at reset
Smart card interface function
Card presence
P1.2
CPRES
Quasi-bidirectional port supplied by VCC
Low level at reset
Smart card interface function
Card contact 4
Quasi-bidirectional port supplied by
DC/DC converter
CC4
Caution : if DPU bit is set in AUXR register, the
weak-pull of the port is disabled
Smart card interface function
Card clock
Push-Pull port supplied by DC/DC
converter
CCLK
Low level at reset
Low level at reset
Smart card interface function
Card reset
Push-Pull port supplied by DC/DC
converter
CRST
SS
P1.6
P1.7
SS pin of the SPI function
Quasi-bidirectional supplied by VCC
Quasi-bidirectional supplied by VCC
Alternate Card Clock function disabled
Alternate Smart Card Clock enabled
Switched automatically to Push-pull (see Table
47 on page 82 )
CCLK1
Alternate Card Clock output
Quasi-bidirectional supplied by VCC
Port 2
Port 2 has the following functions:
–
–
Default function: Port 2 is an 8-bit I/O port.
Alternate function 1: Port 2 is also the multiplexed high-order address during
accesses to external Program and Data Memory. In this application, it uses
strong internal pull-ups when emitting 1’s and it can drive CMOS inputs
without external pull-ups.
Port 2 has the following configurations:
–
Default configuration: Pseudo bi-directional “Port51” digital input/output with
internal pull-ups.
–
–
–
Configuration 1: Push-pull output
Configuration 2: Low speed output, “KB_OUT
Configuration 3: Input with weak pull-up, “WPU input”
54
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Port 3
Port 3 has the following functions:
–
–
Default function: Port 3 is an 8-bit I/O port.
Alternate functions: see table below
Port 3 has the following configurations:
–
Default configuration: Pseudo bi-directional “Port51” digital input/output with
internal pull-ups.
–
Alternate configurations: See Table 32.
Table 32. Port 3 Description
Alternate Functions
Configurations
Mode 1
Port
Signal
Description
Mode 2
Mode 3
Mode 4
Receiver data input (asynchronous) or data input/output
(synchronous) of the serial interface
P3.0
RxD
Push-pull
Push-pull
KB_OUT
Input WPU
Transmitter data output (asynchronous) or clock output
(synchronous) of the serial interface
P3.1
TxD
KB_OUT
Input WPU
P3.2
P3.3
P3.4
P3.5
INT0
INT1
T0
External interrupt 0 input/timer 0 gate control input
External interrupt 1input/timer 1 gate control input
Timer 0 counter input
LED0
LED1
Push-pull
Push-pull
KB_OUT
KB_OUT
Input WPU
Input WPU
T1
Timer 1 counter input
External Data Memory write strobe; latches the data byte
from port 0 into the external data memory
P3.6
P3.7
WR
RD
LED2
LED3
External Data Memory read strobe; Enables the external
data memory. Port 3 can drive CMOS inputs without external
pull-ups
55
4202D–SCR–06/05
Port 4
Port 4 has the following functions:
–
–
Default function: Port 4 is an 6-bit I/O port.
Alternate functions: see table below
Port 4 has the following configurations:
–
Default configuration: Pseudo bi-directional “Port51” digital input/output with
internal pull-ups.
–
Alternate configurations: See Table 33.
Table 33. Port 4 Description
Alternate Functions
Configurations
Mode 1
Port
P4.0
P4.1
P4.2
P4.3
P4.4
P4.5
Signal
MISO
MOSI
SCK
Description
Mode 2
Mode 3
SPI Master In Slave Out I/O
SPI Master Out Slave In I/O
SPI clock
Push-pull
Push-pull
Push-pull
KB_OUT
KB_OUT
KB_OUT
Input MPU
Input MPU
Input MPU
Port 5
Port 5 has the following functions:
–
–
Default function: Port 5 is an 8-bit I/O port.
Alternate function 1: Port 5 is an 8-bit keyboard port KB0 to KB7.
Port 5 has the following configurations:
–
Default configuration: Pseudo bi-directional “Port51” digital input/output with
internal pull-ups.
–
Alternate configuration: see Table 34.
Table 34. Port 5 Description
Configurations
Port
P5.0
P5.1
P5.2
P5.3
P5.4
P5.5
P5.6
P5.7
Mode 1
Push-pull
Push-pull
Push-pull
Push-pull
Push-pull
Push-pull
Push-pull
Push-pull
Mode 2
Mode 3
Comments
Input MPU
Input MPU
Input MPU
Input WPD
Input WPD
Input WPD
Input WPD
Input WPD
Input WPU
Input WPU
Input WPU
Input WPU
Input WPU
Input WPU
Input WPU
Input WPU
First cluster
Second cluster
Third cluster
56
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Port Configuration
Standard I/O P0
The P0 port is described in Figure 23.
Figure 23. Standard Input/Output Port
Vcc
CONTROL
ADDR/DATA
PMOS
Pin
NMOS
1
Port latch
Data
0
MUX
Vss
Input
Data
Quasi Bi-directional Port
The default port output configuration for standard I/O ports is the quasi-bi-directional
output that is common on the 80C51 and most of its derivatives. The “Port51” output
type can be used as both an input and output without the need to reconfigure the port.
This is possible because when the port outputs a logic high, it is weakly driven, allowing
an external device to pull the pin low.
When the port outputs a logic low state, it is driven strongly and is able to sink a fairly
large current.
These features are somewhat similar to an open-drain output except that there are three
pull-up transistors in the quasi-bi-directional output that serve different purposes.
One of these pull-ups, called the weak pull-up, is turned on whenever the port latch for
the pin contains a logic 1. The weak pull-up sources a very small current that will pull the
pin high if it is left floating. The weak pull-up can be turned off by the DPU bit in AUXR
register.
A second pull-up, called the medium pull-up, is turned on when the port latch for the pin
contains a logic 1 and the pin itself is also at a logic 1 level. This pull-up provides the pri-
mary source current for a quasi-bi-directional pin that is outputting a 1. If a pin that has a
logic 1 on it is pulled low by an external device, the medium pull-up turns off, and only
the weak pull-up remains on. In order to pull the pin low under these conditions, the
external device has to sink enough current to overpower the medium pull-up and take
the voltage on the port pin below its input threshold.
Note:
for CIO, CC4, CC8 ports of SCIB interface , in input mode when the ICC (smart card) is
driving the port pin :
–
if 0 < Vin < CVCC/2 : weak pull-up is active (~100KOhm)
–
if CVCC/2 < Vin < CVCC : weak (~100KOhm) and medium (~12KOhm) pull-
up’s are active
57
4202D–SCR–06/05
The “Port51” is described in Figure 24.
Figure 24. Quasi Bi-directional Port
DPU (AUXR.7)
vcc
P
vcc
P
vcc
P
2 CPU
CLOCK DELAY
Strong
Weak
Medium
Pin
N
Port Latch
Data
Vss
Input
Data
Push-pull Output
Configuration
The push-pull output configuration has the same pull-down structure as both the open
drain and the quasi-bi-directional output modes, but provides a continuous strong pull-
up when the port latch contains a logic 1. The push-pull mode may be used when more
source current is needed from a port output.
The Push-pull port configuration is shown in Figure 25.
Figure 25. Push-pull Output
P
Strong
PMOS
Pin
Port latch
Data
N
NMOS
Input with Medium or Weak
Pull-up Configuration
The input with pull-up (Input MPU and Input WPU) configuration is shown in Figure 26.
58
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 26. Input with Pull-up
P
Stuck to 0 if Medium
Stuck to 0 if Weak
Medium
P
Weak
Input
Data
Pin
Input with Weak Pull-down
Configuration
The input with pull-down (input WPD) configuration is shown in Figure 27
Figure 27. Input with Pull-down
Input
Data
Pin
Weak
N
1
Low Speed Output
Configuration
The low speed output with low speed tFALL and tRISE can drive keyboard.
The current limitation of the LED2CTRL block requires a polarisation current of about
250 µA. This block is automatically disabled in power-down mode.
The low speed output configuration (KB_OUT) is shown in Figure 28.
Figure 28. Low-speed Output
P
PWEAKCTRL
Weak
Pin
Port latch
Data
N
NMOS
N
LED2CTRL
PCON.1
LED Source Current
The LED configuration is shown in Figure 29.
59
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 29. LED Source Current
Pin
NMOS
N
LEDx.0
N
Port Latch
LEDCTRL
Data
LEDx.1
Notes: 1. When switching a low level, LEDCTRL device has a permanent current of about
N mA/15 (N is 2, 4 or 8).
2. The port must be configured as standard C51 port by means of PMOD0 and PMOD1
registers and the level of current must be programmed by means of LEDCON0 and
LEDCON1 registers before switching the led on.
Table 35. LED Source Current
LEDx.1
LEDx.0
Port Latch Data
NMOS
PIN
0
Comments
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
LED control disabled
1
0
LED mode 2 mA
LED mode 4 mA
LED mode 10 mA
1
0
1
0
1
60
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Registers
Table 36. Port Mode Register 0 - PMOD0 (91h) for AT8xC5122
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P3C1
P3C0
P2C1
P2C0
CPRESRES
-
P0C1
P0C0
Bit Number Bit Mnemonic Description
Port 3 Configuration bits (Applicable to P3.0, P3.1, P3.3, P3.4 only)
00 Quasi bi-directional
P3C1-P3C0 01 Push-pull
7 - 6
5-4
10 Output Low Speed
11 Input with weak pull-up
Port 2 Configuration bits
00 Quasi bi-directional
P2C1-P2C0 01 Push-pull
10 Output Low Speed
11 Input with weak pull-down
Card Presence Pull-up resistor
CPRESRES Cleared to connect the internal 100K pull-up
Set to disconnect the internal pull-up
3
2
Reserved
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not set this bit.
Port 0 Configuration bits
00 C51 Standard P0
P0C1-P0C0 01 Reserved
1-0
10 Output Low Speed
11 Push-pull
Reset Value = 0000 0x00b
Table 37. Port Mode Register 0 - PMOD0 (91h) for AT83C5123
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P3C1
P3C0
-
-
CPRESRES
-
-
-
Bit Number Bit Mnemonic Description
Port 3 Configuration bits (Applicable to P3.0, P3.1, P3.3, P3.4 only)
00 Quasi bi-directional
P3C1-P3C0 01 Push-pull
7 - 6
10 Output Low Speed
11 Input with weak pull-up
Reserved
5-4
3
The value read from these bits are indeterminate. Do not set these bit.
Card Presence Pull-up resistor
CPRESRES Cleared to connect the internal 100K pull-up
Set to disconnect the internal pull-up
Reserved
2-0
-
The value read from these bits are indeterminate. Do not set these bit.
Reset Value = 00xx 0xxxb
61
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 38. Port Mode Register 1 - PMOD1 (84h) for AT8xC5122
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
P5HC1
P5HC0
P5MC1
P5MC0
P5LC1
P5LC0
P4C1
P4C0
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic Description
Port 5 High Configuration bits (Applicable from P5.6 to P5.7 only)
00 Quasi bi-directional
P5HC1-P5HC0 01 Push-pull
7 - 6
10 Input with weak pull-down
11 Input with weak pull-up
Port 5 Medium Configuration bits (Applicable from P5.3 to P5.5 only)
00 Quasi bi-directional
P5MC1-P5MC0 01 Push-pull
5 - 4
3 - 2
10 Input with weak pull-down
11 Input with weak pull-up
Port 5 Low Configuration bits (Applicable from P5.0 to P5.2 only)
00 Quasi bi-directional
P5LC1-P5LC0 01 Push-pull
10 Input with medium pull-up
11 Input with weak pull-up
Port 4 Configuration bits (Applicable from P4.3 to P4.5 only)
00 Quasi bi-directional
P4C1-P4C0 01 Push-pull
1 - 0
10 Output Low Speed
11 Input with medium pull-up
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
Table 39. Port Mode Register 1 - PMOD1 (84h) for AT83C5123
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
-
P5LC1
P5LC0
-
-
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7 - 4
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not set this bit.
Port 5 Low Configuration bits (Applicable from P5.0 to P5.2 only)
00 Quasi bi-directional
P5LC1-P5LC0 01 Push-pull
3 - 2
10 Input with medium pull-up
11 Input with weak pull-up
Reserved
1 - 0
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not set this bit.
Reset Value = xxxx 00xxb
62
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 40. LED Port Control Register 0 - LEDCON0 (F1h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
LED3.1
LED3.0
LED2.1
LED2.0
LED1.1
LED1.0
LED0.1
LED0.0
Bit Number Bit Mnemonic Description
Port LED3 Configuration bits
00 LED control disabled
7 - 6
5 - 4
3 - 2
1 - 0
LED3
LED2
LED1
LED0
01 2 mA current source when P3.7 is configured as Quasi-bi-directional mode
10 4 mA current source when P3.7 is configured as Quasi-bi-directional mode
11 10 mA current source when P3.7 is configured as Quasi-bidirect. mode
Port LED2 Configuration bits
00 LED control disabled
01 2 mA current source when P3.6 is configured as Quasi-bi-directional mode
10 4 mA current source when P3.6 is configured as Quasi-bi-directional mode
11 10 mA current source when P3.6 is configured as Quasi-bidirect. mode
Port LED1 Configuration bits
00 LED control disabled
01 2 mA current source when P3.4 is configured as Quasi-bi-directional mode
10 4 mA current source when P3.4 is configured as Quasi-bi-directional mode
11 10 mA current source when P3.4 is configured as Quasi-bidirect. mode
Port LED0 Configuration bits
00 LED control disabled
01 2 mA current source when P3.2 is configured as Quasi-bi-directional mode
10 4 mA current source when P3.2 is configured as Quasi-bi-directional mode
11 10 mA current source when P3.2 is configured as Quasi-bidirect. mode
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
Table 41. LED Port Control Register 1- LEDCON1 (F1h) only for AT8xC5122
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
LED6.1
LED6.0
LED5.1
LED5.0
LED4.1
LED4.0
Bit Number Bit Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7 - 6
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not set this bit.
Port LED6 Configuration bits
00 LED control disabled
5 - 4
3 - 2
1 - 0
LED6
LED5
LED4
01 2 mA current source when P4.5 is configured as Quasi-bi-directional mode
10 4 mA current source when P4.5 is configured as Quasi-bi-directional mode
11 10 mA current source when P4.5 is configured as Quasi-bidirect. mode
Port LED5 Configuration bits
00 LED control disabled
01 2 mA current source when P4.4 is configured as Quasi-bi-directional mode
10 4 mA current source when P4.4 is configured as Quasi-bi-directional mode
11 10 mA current source when P4.4 is configured as Quasi-bidirect. mode
Port LED0 Configuration bits
00 LED control disabled
01 2 mA current source when P4.3 is configured as Quasi-bi-directional mode
10 4 mA current source when P4.3 is configured as Quasi-bi-directional mode
11 10 mA current source when P4.3 is configured as Quasi-bidirect. mode
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
63
4202D–SCR–06/05
Smart Card Interface The SCIB provides all signals to interface directly with a smart card. The compliance
with the ISO7816, EMV’2000, GSM and WHQL standards has been certified.
Block (SCIB)
Both synchronous (e.g. memory card) and asynchronous smart cards (e.g. micropro-
cessor card) are supported. The component supplies the different voltages requested by
the smart card. The power off sequence is directly managed by the SCIB.
The card presence switch of the smart card connector is used to detect card insertion or
card removal. In case of card removal, the SCIB de-activates the smart card using the
de-activation sequence. An interrupt can be generated when a card is inserted or
removed.
Any malfunction is reported to the microcontroller (interrupt + control register).
The different operating modes are configured by internal registers.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Support of ISO/IEC 7816
character mode
one transmit/receive buffer
11 bits ETU counter
9 bits guard time counter
32 bits waiting time counter
Auto character repetition on error signal detection in transmit mode
Auto error signal generation on parity error detection in receive mode
Power on and power off sequence generation
Manual mode to drive directly the card I/O
64
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Block Diagram
The Smart Card Interface Block diagram is shown Figure 30:
Figure 30. SCIB Block Diagram
Barrel shifter
IO (in)
Clk_iso
Clk_cpu
IO (out)
CLK
RST
I/O
mux
Etu counter
Scart
fsm
Guard time counter
Waiting time counter
C4 (out)
C8 (out)
C4 (in)
C8 (in)
SCI Registers
Power on
INT
Interrupt generator
VCARD
Power off
fsm
Definitions
This paragraph introduces some of the terms used in ISO 7816-3 and EMV recommen-
dations. Please refer to the full recommendations for a complete list of terms.
Terminal and ICC
Terminal is the reader, ICC is the Integrated Circuit Card
Elementary Timing Unit (Bit time)
ETU
T=0
Character oriented half duplex protocol T=0
Block oriented half duplex protocol T=1
T=1
Activation: Cold Reset
Reset initiated by the Terminal with Vcc power-up. The card will answer with ATR (see
below)
Activation: Warm Reset
De-Activation
Reset initiated by the Terminal with Vcc already powered-up, and after a prior ATR or
Warm Reset
Deactivation by the Terminal as a result of : unresponsive ICC, or ICC removal.
65
4202D–SCR–06/05
ATR
Answer To Reset. Response from the ICC to a Reset initiated by the Terminal
F and D
F = Clock Rate Conversion Factor, D = Bit rate adjustment factor. ETU is defined as :
ETU = F/(D*f) with f = Card Clock frequency. If f is in Hertz, ETU is in second. F and D
are available in the ATR (byte TA1). The default values are F=372, D=1.
Guard Time
The time between 2 leading edges of the start bit of 2 consecutive characters is com-
prised of the character duration (10) plus the guard time. Be aware that the Guard Time
counter and the Guard Time registers in the AT8xC5122/23 consider the time between 2
consecutive characters. So the equation is Guard Time Counter = Guard Time + 10. In
other words, the Guard Time is the number of Stop Bits between 2 characters sent in
the same direction.
Extra Guard Time
ISO IEC 7816-3 and EMV introduce the Extra Guard time to be added to the minimum
Guard Time. Extra Guard Time only apply to consecutive characters sent by the termi-
nal to the ICC. The TC1 byte in the ATR define the number N. For N=0 the character to
character duration is 12 ETUs. For N=254 the character to character duration is 266. For
N=255 (special case) The minimum character to character duration is to be used : 12 for
T=0 protocol and 11 for T=1 protocol.
Block Guard Time
The time between the leading edges of 2 consecutive characters sent in opposit direc-
tion. ISO IEC 7816-3 and EMV recommend a fixed Block Guard Time of 22 ETUs.
Work Waiting Time (WWT)
In T=0 protocol WWT is the interval between the leading edge of any character sent by
the ICC, and the leading edge of the previous character sent either by the ICC or the
Terminal. If no character is received by the terminal after WWTmax time, the Terminal
initiates a De-Activation Sequence.
Character Waiting Time (CWT) In T=1 protocol CWT is the interval between the leading edge of 2 consecutive charac-
ters sent by the ICC. If the next character is not received by the Terminal after CWTmax
time, the Terminal initiates a De-Activation Sequence.
Block Waiting Time (BWT)
In T=1 protocol BWT is the interval between the leading edge of the start bit of the last
character sent by the Terminal that gives the right to sent to the ICC, and the leading
edge of the start bit of the first character sent by the ICC. If the first character from the
ICC is not received by the Terminal after BWTmax time, the Terminal initiates a De-Acti-
vation Sequence.
Waiting Time Extention (WTX) In T=1 protocol the ICC can request a Waiting Time Extension with a S(WTX request)
request. The Terminal should acknowlege it. The Waiting time between the leading
edge of the start bit of the last character sent by the Terminal that gives the right to sent
to the ICC, and the leading edge of the start bit of the first character sent by the ICC will
be BWT*WTX ETUs.
Parity error in T=0 protocol
In T=0 protocol, a Terminal (respectively an ICC) detecting a parity error while receiving
a character shall force the Card IO line at 0 starting at 10.5 ETUs, thus reducing the first
Guard bit by half the time. The Terminal (respectively an ICC) shall maintain a 0 for 1
ETU min and 2 ETUs max (according to ISO IEC) or to 2 ETUs (according to EMV). The
ICC (respectively a Terminal) shall monitor the Card IO to detect this error signal then
attempt to repeat the character. According to EMV, following a parity error the character
can be repeated one time, if parity error is detected again this procedure can be
repeated 3 more times. The same character can be transmitted 5 times in total. ISO
66
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
IEC7816-3 says this procedure is mandatory in ATR for card supporting T=0 while EMV
says this procedure is mandatory for T=0 but does not apply for ATR.
Functional Description
The architecture of the Smart Card Interface Block can be detailed as follows:
Barrel Shifter
The Barrel Shifter performs the translation between 1 bit serial data and 8 bits parallel
data
The barrel function is useful for character repetition since the character is still present in
the shifter at the end of the character transmission.
This shifter is able to shift the data in both directions and to invert the input or output
value in order to manage both direct and inverse ISO7816-3 convention.
Coupled with the barrel shifter is a parity checker and generator.
There are 2 registers connected to this barrel shifter, one for the transmission and one
for the reception. They act as buffers to relieve the CPU of timing constraints.
SCART FSM
(Smart Card Asynchronous Receiver Transmitter Finite State Machine)
This is the core of the block. Its purpose is to control the barrel shifter. To sequence cor-
rectly the barrel shifter for a reception or a transmission, it uses the signals issued by the
different counters. One of the most important counters is the guard time counter that
gives time slots corresponding to the character frame.
The SCART FSM is enabled only in UART mode.
The transition from the receipt mode to the transmit mode is done automatically. Priority
is given to the transmission. Transmission refers to Terminal transmission to the ICC.
Reception refers to reception by the Terminal from the ICC.
ETU Counter
The ETU (Elementary Timing Unit) counter controls the working frequency of the barrel
shifter, in fact it generates the enable signal of the barrel shifter. It receives the Card
Clock, and generates the ETU clock. The Card Clock frequency is called “f” below. The
ETU counter is 11 bit wide.
A special compensation mode can be activated. It accomodates situations where the
ETU is not an integer number of Card Clock (CK_ISO). The compensation mode is con-
trolled by the COMP bit in SCETU1 register bit position 7. With COMP=1 the ETU of
every character even bits is reduced by 1 Card Clock period. As a result, the average
ETU is : ETU_average = (ETU - 0.5). One should bear in mind that the ETU counter
should be programmed to deliver a faster ETU which will be reduced by the COMP
mechanism, not the other way around. This allows to reach the required precision of the
character duration specified by the ISO7816-3 standard.
Example1 : F=372, D=32 => ETU= F/D = 11.625 clock cycles.
We select ETU[10-0] = 12 , COMP=1. ETUaverage= 12 - (0.5*COMP) = 11.5
The result will be a full character duration (10 bit) = (10 - 0.107)*ETU. The EMV specifi-
cation is (10 +/- 0.2)*ETU
Guard Time Counter
The minimum time between the leading edge of the start bit of 2 consecutive characters
transmitted by the Terminal is controlled by the Guard Time counter, as described in
Figure 33.
67
4202D–SCR–06/05
The Guard Time counter is an 9 bit counter It is initialized at 001h at the start of a trans-
mission by the Terminal. It then increments itself at each ETU until it reach the 9 bit
value loaded into the SCGT1[0] concatenated with SCGT0[7:0]. At this time a new Ter-
minal transmission is enabled and the Guard Time Counter stop incrementing. As soon
as a new transmission start, the Guard Time Counter is re-initialized at 1 decimal value.
It should be noted that the value of the Guard Time Counter cannot be red. Reading
SCGT1,0 only gives the minimum time between 2 characters that the Guard Time
Counter will allow.
Care must be taken with the Guard Time Counter which counts the duration between
the leading edges of 2 consecutive characters. This correspond to the character dura-
tion (10 ETU) plus the Guard Time as defined by the ISO and EMV recommendations.
To program Guard Time = 2 : 2 stop bits between 2 characters which is equivalent to the
minimum delay of 12 ETUs between the leading edges of 2 consecutive characters,
SCGT1[0],SCGT0[7:0] should be loaded with the value 12 decimal. See Figure 31
Figure 31. Guard Time.
TRANSMISSION to ICC
CHAR n+1
>= SCGT
CHAR n+2
CHAR n+3
Block Guard Time Counter
The Block Guard Time counter provides a way to program a minimum time between the
leading edge of the start bit of a character received from the ICC and the leading edge of
the start bit of a character sent by the terminal. ISO IEC 7816-3 and EMV recommend a
fixed Block Guard Time of 22 ETUs. The AT8xC5122/23 offer the possibility to extend
this delay up to 512 ETUs.
The Block Guard Time is a 9 bit counter. When the Block Guard Time mode is enabled
(BGTEN=1 in SCSR register) The Block Guard Time counter is initialized at 000h at the
start of each character transmissions from the ICC. It then increments at each ETU until
it reach the 9 bit value loaded into shadow SCGT1,0 registers, or until it is re-initialized
by the start of an new transmission from the ICC. If the Block Guard Time counter
reaches the 9 bit value loaded into shadow SCGT1,0 registers, a transmission by the
TERMINAL is enabled, and the Block Guard Time counter stop incrementing. The Block
Guard Time counter is re-initialized at the start of each TERMINAL transmission.
The SCGT1 SCGT0 shadow registers are loaded with the content of GT[8-0] contained
in the registers SCGT1[0),SCGT0(7:0] with the rising edge of the bit BGTEN in the
SCSR register. See Figure 33.
68
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 32. Block Guard Time.
RECEPTION from ICC
TRANSMISSION to ICC
Write SCGT1,0 with
a value for Guard Time
CHAR n
CHAR n+2
CHAR 1
CHAR 2
CHAR n+1
CHAR n+3
>= SCGT
>= Block Guard Time
Write “Block Guard Time” in SCGT1,0
and set BGTEN to transfer the value to the
shadow SCGT1,0 registers
Figure 33. Guard Time and Block Guard Time counters
ETU Counter
Guard Time Counter
9 bits
Block Guard Time Counter
9 bits
Comparator
Comparator
Enable
Enable
9 bits
9 bits
transmit
transmit
Shadow SCGT1 ,Shadow SCGT0
GT[8:0]
SCGT1
SCGT0
To illustrate the use of Guard Time and Block Guard Time, let us consider the
ISO/IEC7816-3 recommendation : Guard Time = 2 (minimum delay between 2 consecu-
tive characters sent by the Terminal = 12 ETUs), and Block Guard Time = 22 ETUs.
After A smart Card Reset
–
–
Write 00decimal in SCGT1, Write 21decimal in SCGT0
Set BGTEN in SCSR (BGTEN was 0 before as a result of the smart card
reset)
–
Write 12decimal in SCGT0
Now the Guard Time and Block Guard Time are properly initialized. The TERMINAL will
insure a minimun 12 ETUs between 2 leading edges of 2 consecutive characters trans-
mitted. The TERMINAL will also insure a minimum of 22 ETUs between the leading
edge of a character sent by the ICC, and the leading edge of a character sent by the
TERMINAL. There is no need to write SCGT1,0 again and again.
Waiting Time (WT) Counter
The WT counter is a 32 bits down counter which can be loaded with the value contained
in the SCWT3, SCWT2, SCWT1, SCWT0 registers. Its main purpose is timeout signal
generation. It is 32 bits wide and is decremented at the ETU rate. see Figure 34.
69
4202D–SCR–06/05
When the WT counter times out, an interrupt is generated and the SCIB function is
locked: reception and emission are disabled. It can be enabled by resetting the macro or
reloading the counter.
The Waiting Time Counter can be used in T=0 protocol for the Work Waiting Time. It can
be used in T=1 protocol for the Character Waiting Time and for the Block Waiting Time.
See the detailed explanation below.
Figure 34. Waiting Time Counter
ETU Counter
WTEN
WT Counter
Load
Timeout
SCWT0
Write_SCWT2
WT[31:0]
SCWT1
UART
Start Bit
SCWT2
SCWT3
In the so called manuel mode, the counter is loaded, if WTEN = 0, during the write of
SCWT2 register. The counter is loaded with a 32 bit word built with SCWT3 SCWT2
SCWT1 SCWT0 registers (SCWT0 contain WT[7-0] byte. WTEN is located in the
SCICR register.
When WTEN=1 and in UART mode, the counter is re-loaded at the occurence of a start
bit. This mode will be detailed below in T=0 protocol and T=1 protocol.
In manual mode, the WTEN signal controls the start of the counter (rising edge) and the
stop of the counter (falling edge). After a timeout of the counter, a falling edge on
WTEN, a reload of SCWT2 and a rising edge of WTEN are necessary to start again the
counter and to release the SCIB macro. The reload of SCWT2 transfers all SCWT0,
SCWT1, SCWT2 and SCWT3 registers to the WT counter.
In UART mode there is an automatic load on the start bit detection. This automatic load
is very useful for changing on-the-fly the timeout value since there is a register to hold
the load value. This is the case for T=1 protocol.
In T=0 protocol the maximun interval between the start leading edge of any character
sent by the ICC and the start of the previous character sent by either the ICC or the Ter-
minal is the maximum Work Waiting Time. The Work Waiting Time shall not exceed
960*D*WI ETUs with D and WI parameters are returned by the field TA1 and TC2
respectively in the Answer To Reset (ATR). This is the value the user shall write in the
SCWT0,1,2,3 register. This value will be reloaded in the Waiting Time counter every
start bit.
70
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 35. T=0 mode
> GT
CHAR 1
CHAR 2
< WT
In T=1 protocol : The maximum interval between the leading edge of the start bit of 2
consecutive characters sent by the ICC is called maximum Character Waiting Time. The
Character Waiting Time shall not exceed (2**CWI + 11) ETUs with 0 =< BWI =< 5. Con-
sequently 12 ETUs =< CWT =< 43 ETUs.
T=1 protocol also specify the maximum Block Waiting Time. This is the time between
the leading edge of the last character sent by the Terminal giving the right to send to the
ICC, and the leading edge of the start bit of the first character sent by the ICC. The
Block Waiting Time shall not exceed (2**BWI*960 + 11) ETUs with 0 =< BWI =< 4. Con-
sequently 971 ETUs =< BWT =< 15371 ETUs.
In T=1 protocol it is possible to extend the Block Waiting Time with the Waiting Time
Extension (WTX). When selected the waiting time becomes BWT*WTX ETUs. The
Waiting Time counter is 32 bit wide to accomodate this feature.
It is possible to take advantage of the automatic reload of the Waiting Time counter with
a start bit in UART mode (T=1 protocol use UART mode) . If the Terminal sends a block
of N characters, and the ICC is supposed to respond immediately after, then the follow-
ing sequence can be used.
While sending the (N-1)th character of the block, the Terminal can write the
SCWT0,1,2,3 with BWImax.
At the start bit of the Nth character, the BWImax is loaded in the Waiting Time counter
During the transmission of the Nth character, the Terminal can write SCWT0,1,2,3 with
the CWImax.
At the start bit of the first character sent by the ICC, the CWImax will be loaded in the
Waiting Time counter.
Figure 36. T=1 Mode
RECEPTION
TRANSMISSION
BLOC 1
BLOC 2
CHAR n
CHAR n+2
CHAR 1
CHAR 2
CHAR n+1
< CWT
CHAR n+3
< BWT
71
4202D–SCR–06/05
Power-on and Power-off FSM The Power-on Power-off Finite State Machine (FSM) applies the signals on the smart
card in accordance with ISO7816-3 standard. It conducts the Activation (Cold Reset and
Warm Reset as well as De-Activation) it also manages the exception conditions such as
overcurrent (see DC/DC Converter)
To be able to power on the SCIB, the card presence is mandatory. Upon detectection of
a card presence, the Terminal initiate a Cold Reset Activation.
The Cold Reset Activation Terminal procedure is as follow and the Figure 37. Timing
indications are given according to ISO IEC 7816
–
–
–
–
–
RESET= Low , I/O in the receive state
Power Vcc (see DC/DC Converter)
Once Vcc is established, apply Clock at time Ta
Maintain Reset Low until time Ta+tb (tb< 400 clocks)
Monitor The I/O line for the Answer To Reset (ATR) between 400 and 40000
clock cycles after Tb. ( 400 clocks < tc < 40000clocks)
Figure 37. SCIB Activation Cold Reset Sequence after a Card Insertion
CVCC
CRST
CCLK
CIO
Undefined
Ta
Data
Tb+tc
Ta+tb
The Warm Reset Activation Terminal procedure is as follow and the Figure 38
–
–
Vcc active, Reset = High, CLK active
Terminal drive Reset low at time T to initiate the warm Reset. Reset=0
maintained for at least 400 clocks until time Td = T+te (400 clocks < te)
–
–
–
Terminal keep the IO line in receive state
Terminal drive Reset high after at least 400 clocks at time Td
ICC shall respond with an ATR within 40000 clocks (tf<40000 clocks)
Figure 38. SCIB Activation Warm Reset Sequence
CVCC
CRST
CCLK
Undefined
T
Data
Td + tf
CIO
Td=T + te
72
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Removal of the smart card will automatically start the power off sequence as described
in Figure 39.
The SCIB deactivation sequence after a reset of the CPU or after a lost of power supply
is ISO7816-3 compliant. The switching order of the signals is the same as in Figure 39
but the delay between signals is analog and not clock dependant.
Figure 39. SCIB Deactivation Sequence after a Card Extraction
CVCC
CRST
CCLK
CIO
8 Clock Cycles
Interrupt Generator
There are several sources of interruption but the SCIB macro-cell issues only one inter-
rupt signal: SCIBIT.
Figure 40. SCIB Interrupt Sources
Transmit buffer
copied to shift register
SCTBI
ESCTBI
ICARDERR
ICARDER
VCARDERR
Output current
out of range
Output voltage
out of range
EVCARDER
Timeout on WT
SCIB IT
counter
SCWTI
ESCWTI
ESCTI
Complete
transmission
SCTI
SCRI
Complete
reception
ESCRI
ESCPI
Parity error
detected
SCPI
This signal is high level active. Each of the sources is able to activate the SCIB interrup-
tion which is cleared when the Smart Card Interrupt register is read by the
microcontroller.
If during the read of the Smart Card Interrupt register another interrupt occurs, the acti-
vation of the corresponding bit in the Smart Card Interrupt register and the new SCIB
interruption is delayed until the interrupt register is read by the microcontroller.
Warning : Each bit of the SCIIR register is irrelevant while the corresponding interrup-
tion is disabled in SCIER register. When the interruption mode is not used, the bits of
the SCISR register must be used instead of the bits of the SCIIR register.
73
4202D–SCR–06/05
Additional Features
Clock
The CK_ISO input must be in the range 1 - 5 MHz according to ISO 7816.
The CK_ISO can be programmed up to 12 MHz. In this case, the timing specification of
the output buffer will not comply to ISO 7816.
Figure 41. Clock Diagram of the SCIB Block
CK_IDLE
Ck_cpu
Ck_ISO
CK_PLL or
CK_XTAL1
PR2
SCIB
Figure 42. Prescaler 2 Description
PR2
1/(2*(48 - SCICLK[5-0]))
CK_PLL
0
<48
=48
CK_ISO
CK_XTAL1
1
XTSCS
SCICLK.7
SCICLK[5:0]
EXT48
PLLCON.2
The division factor SCICLK must be smaller than 49. If it is greater or equal to 49, the
PR2 prescaler is locked.
See Figure 17 clock tree diagram in the clock controller chapter.
Table 42. Examples of Clock settings
XTAL1 (MHz)
EXT48
SCICLK
CK_ ISO
8
8
8
8
8
8
0
0
0
0
0
0
36
44
42
40
24
0
4
12
8
6
2
1
Card Presence Input
The internal pull-up (weak pull-up) on Card Presence input can be disconnected in order
to reduce the consumption (CPRESRES, bit 3 in PMOD0).
In this case, an external resistor (typically 1 MΩ) must be externally tied to Vcc.
CPRES input can generate an interrupt (see Interrupt system section).
The detection level can be selected.
74
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Transmit / Receive Buffer
The contents of the SCIBUF Transmit / Receive Buffer is transferred or received into /
from the Shift Register. The Shift Register is not accessible by microcontroller. Its role is
to prepare the byte to be copied on the I/O pin for a transmission or in the SCIBUF
buffer after a reception.
During a character transmission process, as soon as the contents of the SCIBUF buffer
is transferred to the shift register, the SCTBE bit is set in SCISR register to indicate that
the SCIBUF buffer is empty and ready to accept a new byte. This mechanism avoids to
wait for the complete transmission of the previous byte before writing a new byte in the
buffer and enables to speed up the transmission.
–
If the Character repetition mode is not selected (bit CREP=0 in SCICR), as
soon as the contents of the Shift Register is transferred to I/O pin, the SCTC
bit is set in SCISR register to indicate that the byte has been transmitted.
–
If the Character repetition mode is selected (bit CREP=1 in SCICR) The
TERMINAL will be able to repeat characters as requested by the ICC (See
the Parity Error in T=0 protocol description in the definition paragraph
above). The SCTC bit in SCISR register will be set after a successful
transmission (no retry or no further retry requested by the ICC). If the
number of retries is exhausted (up to 4 retries depending on CREPSEL bit in
SCSR) and the last retry is still unsuccessful, the SCTC bit in SCISR will not
be set and the SCPE bit in SCISR register will be set instead.
During a character reception process, the contents of the Shift Register is transferred in
the SCIBUF buffer.
–
If the Character repetition mode is not selected (bit CREP=0 in SCICR), as
soon as the contents of the Shift Register is transferred to the SCIBUF the
SCRC bit is set in SCISR register to indicate that the byte has been
received, and the SCIBUF contains a valid character ready to be red by the
microcontroller.
–
If the Character repetition mode is selected (bit CREP=1 in SCICR) The
TERMINAL will be able to request repetition if the received character exhibit
a parity error. Up to 4 retries can be requested depending on CREPSEL bit
in SCSR. The SCRC bit will be set in SCISR register after a successful
reception, first reception or after retry(ies). If the number of retries is
exhausted (up to 4 retries depending on CREPSEL bit in SCSR) and the last
retry is still unsuccessful, the SCRC bit and the SCPE bit in SCISR register
will be set. It will be possible to read the erroneous character.
Warning : the SCTBI, SCTI SCRI and SCPI bits have the same function as SCTBE,
SCTC, SCRC and SCPE bits. The first ones are able to generate interruptions if the
interruptions are enabled in SCIER register while the second ones are only status bits to
be used in pulling mode. If the interruption mode is not used, the status bits must be
used. The SCTBI, SCTI and SCRI bits do not contain valid information while their
respective interrupt enable bits ESCTBI, EXCTI, ESCRI are cleared.
75
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 43. CharacterTransmission Diagram
SCISR register
SCTBE
SCTC
SCPE
Parity error
Shift Register
SCIBUF
Transmitted
Character
I/O pin
ESCTBI
ESCTI
Parity error
SCPI
SCTI
SCTBI
SCIIR register
76
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 44. Character Reception Diagram
SCISR register
SCTBE
SCPE
SCTC SCRC
Parity error
Shift Register
I/O pin
SCIBUF
Received
Character
ESCTBI
ESCTI
ESCRI
Parity error
SCPI
SCTI
SCRI
SCTBI
SCIIR register
SCIB Reset
The SCICR register contains a reset bit. If set, this bit generates a reset of the SCIB and
its registers. Table 43 defines the SCIB registers that are reset and their reset values.
Table 43. Reset Values for SCI Registers
Register Name
SCIB Reset Value (Binary)
SCICR
0000 0000
SCCON
0X00 0000
SCISR
1000 0000
SCIIR
0X00 0000
SCIER
0X00 0000
SCSR
X000 1000
SCIBUF
0000 0000
SCETU1, SCETU0
SCGT1, SCGT0
SCWT3, SCWT2, SCWT1, SCWT0
SCICLK
XXXX X001, 0111 0100 (372)
0000 0000, 0000 1100 (12)
0000 0000, 0000 0000, 0010 0101, 1000 0000 (9600)
0X10 1111
77
4202D–SCR–06/05
Alternate Card
A second card named ‘Alternate Card’ can be controlled.
The Clock signal CCLK1 can be adapted to the XTAL frequency. Thanks to the clock
prescaler which can divide the frequency by 1, 2, 4 or 8. The bits ALTKPS0 and
ALTKPS1 in SCSR Register are used to set this factor.
Figure 45. Alternate Card
CVCC
CRST
CIO
Main
card
SMART
CARD
CCLK
CPRES
CCLK1
CK_IDLE
1, 1/2, 1/4 or 1/8
P1.7
1
0
SIM, SAM
CARD
Alternate
card
PR3
ALTKPS0,1
SCSR Reg.
SCCLK1
SCSR Reg.
Registers
There are fifteen registers to control the SCIB macro-cell. They are described from
Table 58 to Table 45.
Some of the register widths are greater than a byte. Despite the 8 bits access provided
by the BIU, the address mapping of this kind of register respects the following rule :
The Low significant byte register is implemented at the higher address.
This implementation makes access to these registers easier when using high level pro-
gramming languages (C,C++).
78
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 44. Smart Card Interface Control Register - SCICR (S:B6h, SCRS = 1)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RESET
CARDDET
VCARD1
VCARD0
UART
WTEN
CREP
CONV
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic Description
Reset
Set this bit to reset and deactivate the Smart Card Interface.
Clear this bit to activate the Smart Card Interface.
This bit acts as an active high software reset.
7
RESET
Card Presence Detector Sense
6
CARDDET
Clear this bit to indicate the card presence detector is open when no card is inserted (CPRES is high).
Set this bit to indicate the card presence detector is closed when no card is inserted (CPRES is low).
Card Voltage Selection:
VCARD[1] VCARD[0] CVCC
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0 V
5-4
VCARD[1:0]
1.8 V
3.0 V
5.0 V
Card UART Selection
Clear this bit to use the CARDIO bit (P1.0) bit to drive the Card I/O (P1.0) pin.
Set this bit to use the Smart Card UART to drive the Card I/O pin (P1.0 pin).
Controls also the Waiting Time Counter as described in Section “Waiting Time (WT) Counter”, page 69
3
2
UART
WTEN
Waiting Time Counter Enable
Clear this bit to stop the counter and enable the load of the Waiting Time counter hold registers.
The hold registers are loaded with SCWT0, SCWT1, SCWT2 and SCWT3 values when SCWT2 is written.
Set this bit to start the Waiting Time Counter. The counters stop when it reaches the timeout value.
If the UART bit is set, the Waiting Time Counter automatically reloads with the hold registers whenever a start bit is
sent or received.
Character Repetition
Clear this bit to disable parity error detection and indication on the Card I/O pin in receive mode and to disable
character repetition in transmit mode.
Set this bit to enable parity error indication on the Card I/O pin in receive mode and to set automatic character
repetition when a parity error is indicated in transmit mode.
Depending upon CREPSET bit is SCSR register, the receiver can indicate parity error up to 4times (3 repetitions) or
up to 5times (4 repetitions) after which it will raise the parity error bit SCPE bit in the SCISR register. If parity interrupt
is enabled, the SCPI bit in SCIIR register will be set too.
Alternately, the transmitter will detect ICC character repetition request. After 3 or 4 unsuccessful repetitions
(depending on CREPSEL bit in SCSR register), the transmitter will raise the parity error bit SCPE bit in the SCISR
register. If parity interrupt is enabled, the SCPI bit in SCIIR register will be set too.
1
0
CREP
CONV
Note : Character repetition mode is specified for T=0 protocol only and should not be used in T=1 protocol (block
oriented protocol)
ISO Convention
Clear this bit to use the direct convention: b0 bit (LSB) is sent first, the parity bit is added after b7 bit and a low level
on the Card I/O pin represents a’0’.
Set this bit to use the inverse convention: b7 bit (LSB) is sent first, the parity bit is added after b0 bit and a low level on
the Card I/O pin represents a’1’.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
79
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 45. Smart Card Contacts Register - SCCON (S:ACh, SCRS=0)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CLK
-
CARDC8
CARDC4
CARDIO
CARDCLK
CARDRST
CARDVCC
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic
Description
Card Clock Selection
Clear this bit to use the Card CLK bit (CARDCLK bit below) to drive Card CLK (P1.4) pin.
Set this bit to use CK_XTAL1 or CK_PLL signals for CK_ISO to drive the Card CLK pin (CCLK = P1.4 pin)
7
CLK
Note: internal synchronization avoids glitches on the CLK pin when switching this bit.
Reserved
6
5
-
This bit can be changed by software but the read value is indeterminate.
Card C8
Clear this bit to drive a low level on the Card C8 pin (CC8 = P1.1 pin).
Set this bit to set a high level on the Card C8 pin (CC8 = P1.1 pin)..
CARDC8
The CC8 pin can be used as a pseudo bi-directional I/O when this bit is set.
Warning : VCARDOK=1 (SCISR.4 bit) condition must be true to change the state of CC8 pin
Card C4
Clear this bit to drive a low level on the Card C4 pin (CC4 = P1.3 pin).
Set this bit to set a high level on the Card C4 pin (CC4 = P1.3 pin).
The CC4 pin can be used as a pseudo bi-directional I/O when this bit is set.
4
3
CARDC4
CARDIO
Warning : VCARDOK=1 (SCISR.4 bit) condition must be true to change the state of CC4 pin
Card I/O
If UART bit is cleared in SCICR register, this bit enables the use of the Card IO pin (CIO = P1.0) as a C51
pseudo bi-directional port :
To read from CIO (P1.0) port pin : set CARDIO (P1.0) bit then read CARDIO (P1.0) bit to have the CIO port
value
To write in CIO (P1.0) port pin : set CARDIO (P1.0) bit to write a 1 in CIO (P1.0) port pin , clear CARDIO (P1.0)
bit to write a 0 in CIO (P1.0) port pin.
Warning : VCARDOK=1 (SCISR.4 bit) condition must be true to change the state of CIO pin
Card CLK
When the CLK bit is cleared in SCCON Register, the value of this bit is driven to the Card CLK pin.
2
1
CARDCLK
CARDRST
Warning : VCARDOK=1 (SCISR.4 bit) condition must be true to change the state of Card CLK pin
Card RST
Clear this bit to drive a low level on the Card RST pin.
Set this bit to set a high level on the Card RST pin.
Warning : VCARDOK=1 (SCISR.4 bit) condition must be true to change the state of Card RST pin
Card VCC Control
Clear this bit to desactivate the Card interface and set its power-off. The other bits of SCCON register have no
effect while this bit is cleared.
Set this bit to power-on the Card interface. The activation sequence should be handled by software.
0
CARDVCC
Reset Value = 0X00 0000b
80
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 46. Smart Card UART Interface Status Register -
SCISR (S:ADh, SCRS=0)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SCTBE
CARDIN
ICARDOVF
VCARDOK
SCWTO
SCTC
SCRC
SCPE
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic
Description
UART Transmit Buffer Empty Status
This bit is set by hardware when the Transmit Buffer is copied to the transmit shift register of the Smart Card
7
SCTBE
UART.
It is cleared by hardware when SCIBUF register is written.
Card Presence Status
This bit is set by hardware if there is a card presence (debouncing filter has to be done by software).
6
5
CARDIN
This bit is cleared by hardware if there is no card presence.
Card Current Overflow Status
This bit is set when the current on card is above the limit specified by bit OVFADJ in DCCKPS register (Table 61
on page 94)
It is cleared by hardware.
ICARDOVF
Card Voltage Correct Status
4
3
VCARDOK
SCWTO
This bit is set when the output voltage is within the voltage range specified by VCARD[1:0] in SCICR register.
It is cleared otherwise.
Waiting Time Counter Timeout Status
This bit is set by hardware when the Waiting Time Counter has expired.
It is cleared by the reload of the counter or by the reset of the SCIB.
UART Transmitted Character Status
This bit is set by hardware when the Smart Card UART has transmitted a character. If character repetition mode is
selected, this bit will be set only after a successful transmission. If the last allowed repetition in not successful, this
bit will not be set.
2
1
0
SCTC
SCRC
SCPE
It is cleared by software when this register is read.
UART Received Character Status
This bit is set by hardware when the Smart Card UART has received a character
It is cleared by hardware when SCIBUF register is read. If character repetition mode is selected, this bit will be set
only after a successful reception. If the last allowed repetition is still unsuccessful, this bit will be set to let the user
read the erroneous value if necessary.
Character Reception Parity Error Status
This bit is set when a parity error is detected on the received character.
It is cleared by software when this register is read. If character repetition mode is selected, this bit will be set only
if the ICC report an error on the last allowed repetition of a TERMINAL transmission, or if a reception parity error
is found on the last allowed ICC character repetition.
Reset Value = 1000 0000b
81
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 47. Smart Card UART Interrupt Identification Register (Read Only)
SCIIR (S:AEh, SCRS=0)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SCTBI
-
ICARDERR
VCARDERR
SCWTI
SCTI
SCRI
SCPI
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic
Description
UART Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when the Transmit Buffer is copied into the transmit shift register of the Smart
Card UART. It generates an interrupt if ESCTBI bit is set in SCIER register otherwise this bit is irrelevant.
It is cleared by hardware when this register is read.
7
SCTBI
Reserved
6
5
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Card Current Overflow Interrupt
This bit is set when the current on card is above the limit specified by bit OVFADJ in DCCKPS register (Table
61 on page 94). It generates an interrupt if ICARDER bit is set in SCIER register otherwise this bit is
irrelevant.
ICARDERR
It is cleared by hardware when this register is read.
Card Voltage Error Interrupt
This bit is set when the output voltage goes out of the voltage range specified by VCARD field. It generates
an interrupt if EVCARDER bit is set in SCIER register otherwise this bit is irrelevant.
It is cleared by hardware when this register is read.
4
3
2
1
0
VCARDERR
SCWTI
SCTI
Waiting Time Counter Timeout Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when the Waiting Time Counter has expired. It generates an interrupt if ESCWTI
bit is set in SCIER register otherwise this bit is irrelevant.
It is cleared by hardware when this register is read.
UART Transmitted Character Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when the Smart Card UART has completed the character transmission. It
generates an interrupt if ESCTI bit is set in SCIER register otherwise this bit is irrelevant.
It is cleared by hardware when this register is read.
UART Received Character Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when the Smart Card UART has completed the character reception. It generates
an interrupt if ESCRI bit is set in SCIER register otherwise this bit is irrelevant.
It is cleared by hardware when this register is read.
SCRI
Character Reception Parity Error Interrupt
This bit is set at the same time as SCTI or SCRI if a parity error is detected on the received character. It
generates an interrupt if ESCPI bit is set in SCIER register otherwise this bit is irrelevant.
It is cleared by hardware when this register is read.
SCPI
Reset Value = 0X00 0000b
Note:
1) In case of multiple interrupts occuring at the same time (sampled by the same edge of
the internal clock), the interrupts will be serviced in the following order from the highest to
the lowest priority :
- UART Transmit Buffer Empty
- Card Current Overflow
- Card Voltage Error
- Waiting Time Counter Timeout
- UART Transmitted Character
- UART Received Character
- Character Reception Parity Error
2) It is recommended that the application saves the SCIIR register after reading it in
order to avoid the loss of pending interruptions as the SCIIR register is cleared when it is
read by the MCU.
82
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 48. Smart Card UART Interrupt Enabling Register - SCIER (S:AEh, SCRS=1)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ESCTBI
-
ICARDER
EVCARDER
ESCWTI
ESCTI
ESCRI
ESCPI
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic
Description
UART Transmit Buffer Empty Interrupt Enabled
7
ESCTBI
Clear this bit to disable the Smart Card UART Transmit Buffer Empty interrupt.
Set this bit to enable the Smart Card UART Transmit Buffer Empty interrupt.
Reserved
6
5
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Card Current Overflow Interrupt Enabled
ICARDER
Clear this bit to disable the Card Current Overflow interrupt.
Set this bit to enable the Card Current Overflow interrupt.
Card Voltage Error Interrupt Enabled
4
3
2
1
0
EVCARDER
ESCWTI
ESCTI
Clear this bit to disable the Card Voltage Error interrupt.
Set this bit to enable the Card Voltage Error interrupt.
WaitingTime Counter Timeout Interrupt Enabled
Clear this bit to disable the Waiting Time Counter timeout interrupt.
Set this bit to enable the Waiting Time Counter timeout interrupt.
UART Transmitted Character Interrupt Enabled
Clear this bit to disable the Smart Card UART Transmitted Character interrupt.
Set this bit to enable the Smart Card UART Transmitted Character interrupt.
UART Received Character Interrupt Enabled
ESCRI
Clear this bit to disable the Smart Card UART Received Character interrupt.
Set this bit to enable the Smart Card UART Received Character interrupt.
Character Reception Parity Error Interrupt Enabled
ESCPI
Clear this bit to disable the Smart Card Character Reception Parity Error interrupt.
Set this bit to enable the Smart Card Character Reception Parity Error interrupt.
Reset Value = 0X00 0000b
83
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 49. Smart Card Selection Register - SCSR (S:ABh)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
BGTEN
-
CREPSEL
ALTKPS1
ALTKPS0
SCCLK1
SCRS
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic
Description
Reserved
7
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Block Guard Time Enable
Set this bit to select the minimum interval between the leading edge of the start bits of the last character
received from the ICC and the first character sent by the Terminal. The transfer of GT[8-0] value to the BGT
counter is done on the rising edge of the BGTEN.
6
BGTEN
Clear this bit to suppress the minimum time between reception and transmission.
Reserved
5
4
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Character repetition selection
Clear this bit to select 5 times transmission (1 original + 4 repetitions) before parity error indication (conform to
EMV)
CREPSEL
Set this bit to select 4 times transmission (1 original + 3 repetitions) before parity error indication
Alternate Card Clock prescaler factor
00 ALTKPS = 0: prescaler factor equals 1
01 ALTKPS = 1: prescaler factor equals 2
10 ALTKPS = 2: prescaler factor equals 4 (reset value)
11 ALTKPS = 3: prescaler factor equals 8
3-2
ALTKPS1:0
Alternate card clock selection
Set to select the prescaled PR3 clock for CCLK1 (P1.7) pin
Clear to select P1.7 port bit
1
0
SCCLK1
SCRS
Smart Card Register Selection
The SCRS bit selects which set of the SCIB registers is accessed.
Reset Value = X000 1000b
Table 50. Smart Card Transmit / Receive Buffer - SCIBUF (S:AA)
7
6
-
5
-
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
-
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic Description
Smart Card Transmit / Receive Buffer
- A new byte can be written in the buffer to be transmitted on the I/O pin when SCTBE bit is set.
The bits are sorted and copied on the I/O pin versus the active convention.
-
-
- A new byte received from I/O pin is ready to be read when SCRI bit is set.
The bits are sorted versus the active convention.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
84
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 51. Smart Card ETU Register 1 - SCETU1 (S:ADh, SCRS=1)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
COMP
-
-
-
-
ETU10
ETU9
ETU8
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic Description
Compensation
Clear this bit when no time compensation is needed (i.e. when the ETU to Card CLK period ratio is close to an
integer with an error less than 1/4 of Card CLK period).
Set this bit otherwise and reduce the ETU period by 1 Card CLK cycle for even bits.
7
COMP
Reserved
6-3
2-0
-
The value read from these bits is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
ETU MSB
Used together with the ETU LSB in SCETU0 (Table 52)
ETU[10:8]
Warning : the ETU counter is reloaded at each register’s write operation.
Do not change this register during character reception or transmission or while Guard Time or Waiting Time
Counters are running.
Reset Value = 0XXX X001b
Table 52. Smart Card ETU Register 0 - SCETU0 (S:ACh, SCRS=1)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
ETU7
ETU6
ETU5
ETU4
ETU3
ETU2
ETU1
ETU0
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic Description
ETU LSB
The Elementary Time Unit is (ETU[10:0] - 0.5*COMP)/f, where f is the Card CLK frequency.
According to ISO 7816, ETU[10:0] can be set between 11 and 2048 (2047 ?)
The default reset value of ETU[10:0] is 372 (F=372, D=1).
7 - 0
ETU[7:0]
Reset Value = 0111 0100b
85
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 53. Smart Card Transmit Guard Time Register 0 - SCGT0 (S:B4h, SCRS=1)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
GT7
GT6
GT5
GT4
GT3
GT2
GT1
GT0
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic Description
Transmit Guard Time LSB
The minimum time between two consecutive start bits in transmit mode is GT[8:0] * ETU. This is equal to ISO IEC
Guard Time +10 (see Guard Time Counter description.
According to ISO IEC 7816,the time between 2 consecutive leading edge start bits can be set between 11 and
266 (11 to 254+12 ETUs).
7 - 0
GT[7:0]
Reset Value = 0000 1100b
Table 54. Smart Card Transmit Guard Time Register 1 - SCGT1 (S:B5h, SCRS=1)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
GT8
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7 - 1
-
The value read from these bits is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
Transmit Guard Time MSB
0
GT8
Used together with the Transmit Guard Time LSB in SCGT0 register (Table 53).
Reset Value = XXXX XXX0b
Table 55. Smart Card Character/Block Waiting Time Register 3
SCWT3 (S:C1h, SCRS=0)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WT31
WT30
WT29
WT28
WT27
WT26
WT25
WT24
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic Description
Waiting Time Byte3
7 - 0
WT[31:24]
Used together with WT[23:0] in registers SCWT2,SCWT1, SCWT0 (see Table 56).
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
86
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 56. Smart Card Character/Block Waiting Time Register 2
SCWT2 (S:B6h, SCRS=0)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WT23
WT22
WT21
WT20
WT19
WT18
WT17
WT16
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic Description
Waiting Time Byte2
7 - 0
WT[23:16]
Used together with WT[31:24] and WT[15:0] in registers SCWT3,SCWT1, SCWT0 (see Table 58).
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
Table 57. Smart Card Character/Block Waiting Time Register 1
SCWT1 (S:B5h, SCRS=0)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WT15
WT14
WT13
WT12
WT11
WT10
WT9
WT8
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic Description
Waiting Time Byte 1
7 - 0
WT[15:8]
Used together with WT[31:16] and WT[7:0] in registers SCWT3,SCWT2, SCWT0 (see Table 55).
Reset Value = 0010 0101b
Table 58. Smart Card Character/Block Waiting Time Register 0
SCWT0 (S:B4h, SCRS=0)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
WT7
WT6
WT5
WT4
WT3
WT2
WT1
WT0
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic Description
Waiting Time Byte 0
WT[31:0] is the reload value of the Waiting Time Counter (WTC).
The WTC is a general-purpose timer. It is using the ETU clock and is controlled by the WTEN bit (see Table 44 on
page 79 and Section “Waiting Time (WT) Counter”, page 69).
7 - 0
WT[7:0]
When UART bit of Registers is set, the WTC is automatically reloaded at each start bit of the UART. It is used to
check the maximum time between to consecutive start bits.
Reset Value = 1000 0000b
87
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 59. Smart Card Clock Reload Register - SCICLK (S:C1h, SCRS=1)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
XTSCS
-
SCICLK5
SCICLK4
SCICLK3
SCICLK2
SCICLK1
SCICLK0
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic
Description
Smart Card Clock Selection Bit
If XTSCS bit is set OR EXT48 bit is set (in PLLCON register) , CK_PLL is used to generate CK_ISO.
Otherwise, CK_XTAL1 is used to generate CK_ISO.
7
XTSCS
See the Clock Tree diagram figure 17.
Reserved
6
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
SCIB clock reload register
Prescaler 2 reload value is used to defines the card clock frequency.
If SCICLK[5:0] is smaller than 48 :
5 - 0
SCICLK[5:0]
Fck_iso = Fck_pll or Fck_XTAL1/ (2 * (48 - SCICLK[5:0]))
If SCICLK[5:0] is equal to 48 :
Fck_iso = Fck_XTAL1
SCICLK[5:0] must be smaller than 49.
Reset Value = 0X10 1111b (default value for a divider by two)
DC/DC Converter
The Smart Card voltage (CVCC) is supplied by the integrated DC/DC converter which is
controlled by several registers:
•
•
•
The SCICR register (Table 44 on page 79) controls the CVCC level by means of bits
VCARD[1:0].
The SCCON register (Table 45 on page 80) enables to switch the DC/DC converter
on or off by means of bit CARDVCC.
The DCCKPS register (Table 61 on page 94) controls the DC/DC clock and current.
The DC/DC converter cannot be switched on while the CPRES pin remains inactive. If
CPRES pin becomes inactive while the DC/DC converter is operating an automatic shut
down sequence of the DC/DC converter is initiated by the electronics.
It is mandatory to switch off the DC/DC Converter before entering in Power-down mode.
Configuration
The DC/DC Converter can work in two different modes which are selected by bit MODE
in DCCKPS register:
•
Pump Mode: an external inductance of 10 µH must be connected between pins LI
and VCC. VCC can be higher or lower than CVCC.
•
Regulator mode : no external inductance is required but VCC must be always higher
than CVCC+0.3V. The Regulation mode will work even if an external inductance of
10 µH is connected between pins LI and VCC
The DC/DC clock prescaler which is controlled by bits DCCKPS[3:0], in DCCKPS regis-
ter must be configured to set the DC/DC clock to a working frequency of 4 MHz which
depends upon the value of the crystal. There is no need to change the default configura-
tion set by the reset sequence if an 8 MHz crystal is used by the application.
The DC/DC Converter implements a current overflow controller which avoids permanent
damage of the DC/DC converter in case of short circuit between CVCC and CVSS. The
maximum limit is around 100 mA. It is possible to increase this limit in normal operating
88
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
mode by 20% by means of bit OVFADJ in DCCKPS register. When the current overflow
controller is operating, the ICARDOVF is set by the hardware in SCISR register.
The current drawn from power supply by the DC/DC converter is controlled during the
startup phase in order to avoid high transient current mainly in Pump Mode which could
cause the power supply voltage to drop dramatically. This control is done by means of
bits BOOST[1:0], which increases progressively the startup current level.
Initialization Procedure
The initialization procedure is different depending upon the required Card Vcc. One pro-
cedure apply for Card Vcc =< 3 volts and one procedure for Card Vcc = 5 volts.
The initialization procedure involves :
•
•
•
•
Select the CVCC level by means of bits VCARD[1:0] in SCICR register,
Set bits BOOST[1:0] in DCCKPS register following the current level control wanted.
Switch the DC/DC on by means of bit CARDVCC in SCCON register,
Monitor bit VCARDOK in SCISR register in order to know when the DC/DC
Converter is ready (CVCC voltage has reached the expected level)
Procedure for CVcc =< 3 volts The DC/DC regulation mode must be selected for Card Vcc = 1.8 volts and Card Vcc =
3 volts (MODE = 1 in DCCKPS register) The detailed procedures is described in flow
chart of Figure 46. for Card Vcc = 1.8 volts and in the flow chart of Figure 47. for Card
Vcc = 3 volts
89
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 46. Card Vcc = 1.8V Initialization Procedure
SCICR.7=Reset=1
SCICR.7=Reset=0
VCARD[1:0] = 01
Mode Regulation
DCCKPS[7]=1
BOOST[1:0]=01
SCCON CardVcc=1
Set Timeout to 3 ms
VCARDOK=1
DC/DC Initialization
successful
Timeout
Expired
DC/DC Initialization
Failure
90
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 47. Card Vcc = 3V Initialization Procedure
SCICR.7=Reset=1
SCICR.7=Reset=0
VCARD[1:0] = 10
Mode Regulation
DCCKPS[7]=1
BOOST[1:0]=01
SCCON CardVcc=1
Set Timeout to 3 ms
VCARDOK=1
DC/DC Initialization
successful
Timeout
Expired
DC/DC Initialization
Failure
91
4202D–SCR–06/05
Procedure for CVcc = 5volts
The DC/DC pump mode must be selected (MODE = 0 in DCCKPS register). The
detailed procedure is described in flow chart of Figure 48. VCC must be higher than 4.0
Volts.
Figure 48. Card Vcc = 5V Initialization Procedure
SCICR.7=Reset=1
SCICR.7=Reset=0
VCARD[1:0] = 11
Mode Pump
DCCKPS[7]=0
BOOST[1:0]=[0:0]
SCCON CardVcc=1
Set Timeout to 3 ms
VCARDOK=1
BOOST[1:0]
= [0:0]
Timeout
Expired
Decrement
BOOST[1:0]
BOOST[1:0]
= max = 3?
to adjust the
current overflow
DC/DC Initialization
Successful
Increment
BOOST [1:0]
DC/DC Initialization
Failure
While VCC remains higher than 4.0V and startup current lower than 30 mA (depending
on the load type), the DC/DC converter should be ready without having to increment
BOOST[1:0] bits beyond [0:0] level. If VCC > 4.0V and startup current > 30 mA, it will be
necessary to increment the BOOST[1:0] bits until the DC/DC converter is ready.
92
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Incrementation of BOOST[1:0] bits increases at the same time the current overflow level
in the same proportion as the startup current. So once the DC/DC converter is ready it is
advised to decrement the BOOST[1:0] bits to restore the overflow current to its normal
or desired value.
Monitoring Procedure
Once the DC/DC has been successfuly initialized, it is necessary to monitor the DC/DC
converter by means of bits VCARDOK and ICARDOVF in the SCISR register.
Table 60. DC/DC converter status
VCARDOK
ICARDOVF
DC/DC Status
- Not Started or switched off by application.
The current overflow sensor is disabled during the DC/DC converter startup. Then if a current
overflow condition is applied during the DC/DC converter startup, the DC/DC converter is unable
to start and both bits VCARDOK and ICARDOVF remains at 0.
0
0
DC/DC converter correctly started then the output voltage is out of ISO/IEC 7816-3
specifications. In this case the firmware must take appropriate actions like deactivating the
DC/DC converter in compliance with ISO/IEC 7816.
0
1
1
1
0
1
Started and automatically switched off by a current overflow condition
Operating properly according to ISO/IEC 7816-3 and EMV recommendations
Not applicable
93
4202D–SCR–06/05
DC/DC Converter register
Table 61. DC/DC Converter Control Register - DCCKPS (S:BFh)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MODE
OVFADJ
BOOST1
BOOST0
DCCKPS3
DCCKPS2
DCCKPS1
DCCKPS0
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic
Description
Regulation mode
7
MODE
0 : Pump mode (External Inductance required)
1 : Regulator mode (No External inductance required if VCC > CVCC+0.3V)
Current Overflow Adjustment on Smart Card terminal
0 : normal: 100 mA average
6
OVFADJ
1 : normal + 20%
VCARDOK=0
VCARDOK=1
Maximum Startup Current drawn from power supply Current Overflow Level on Smart Card terminal
00 : Normal: 30 mA average
01 : Normal + 30%
10 : Normal + 50%
00 : Normal = OVFADJ
01 : Normal + 30%
10 : Normal + 50%
11 : Normal + 80%
5 - 4
BOOST[1:0]
11 : Normal + 80%
DC/DC Clock Prescaler Value
0000 : Division factor: 2 (reset value)
0001 : Division factor: 3
0010 : Division factor: 4
0011 : Division factor: 5
3 - 0
DCCKPS[3:0]
0100 : Division factor: 6
0101 : Division factor: 8
0110 : Division factor: 10
0111 : Division factor: 12
1000 : Division factor: 24
Other values are reserved
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
94
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
USB Controller
The AT8xC5122D implements a USB device controller supporting Full Speed data
transfer. In addition to the default control endpoint 0, it provides 6 other endpoints, which
can be configured in Control, Bulk, Interrupt or Isochronous modes:
•
•
•
•
Endpoint 0: 32-byte FIFO, default control endpoint
Endpoint 1,2,3: 8-byte FIFO
Endpoint 4,5: 64-byte FIFO
Endpoint 6: 2 x 64-byte Ping-pong FIFO
This allows the firmware to be developed conforming to most USB device classes, for
example:
•
USB Mass Storage Class Control/Bulk/Interrupt (CBI) Transport, Revision 1.0 -
December 14, 1998.
•
•
•
USB Mass Storage Class Bulk-Only Transport, Revision 1.0 - September 31, 1999.
USB Human Interface Device Class, Version 1.1 - April 7, 1999.
USB Device Firmware Upgrade Class, Revision 1.0 - May 13, 1999.
USB Mass Storage Classes
USB Mass Storage Class CBI
Transport
Within the CBI framework, the Control endpoint is used to transport command blocks as
well as to transport standard USB requests. One Bulk-Out endpoint is used to transport
data from the host to the device. One Bulk-In endpoint is used to transport data from the
device to the host. And one interrupt endpoint may also be used to signal command
completion (protocol 0); it is optional and may not be used (protocol 1).
The following configuration adheres to these requirements:
•
•
•
•
Endpoint 0: 8 bytes, Control In-Out
Endpoint 4: 64 bytes, Bulk-Out
Endpoint 5: 64 bytes, Bulk-In
Endpoint 1: 8 bytes, Interrupt In
USB Mass Storage Class Bulk-
Only Transport
Within the Bulk-Only framework, the Control endpoint is only used to transport class-
specific and standard USB requests for device set-up and configuration. One Bulk-Out
endpoint is used to transport commands and data from the host to the device. One Bulk-
In endpoint is used to transport status and data from the device to the host. No interrupt
endpoint is needed.
The following configuration adheres to these requirements:
•
•
•
Endpoint 0: 8 bytes, Control In-Out
Endpoint 4: 64 bytes, Bulk-Out
Endpoint 5: 64 bytes, Bulk-In
USB Device Firmware
Upgrade (DFU)
The USB Device Firmware Update (DFU) protocol can be used to upgrade the on-chip
program memory of the AT8xC5122D. This allows the implementation of product
enhancements and patches to devices that are already in the field. Two different config-
urations and description sets are used to support DFU functions. The Run-Time
configuration co-exists with the usual functions of the device, which may be USB Mass
Storage for the AT8xC5122D. It is used to initiate DFU from the normal operating mode.
The DFU configuration is used to perform the firmware update after device re-configura-
tion and USB reset. It excludes any other function. Only the default control pipe
(endpoint 0) is used to support DFU services in both configurations.
95
4202D–SCR–06/05
The only possible value for the wMaxPacketSize in the DFU configuration is 32 bytes,
which is the size of the FIFO implemented for endpoint 0.
Description
The USB device controller provides the hardware that the AT8xC5122D and the
AT83C5123 need to interface a USB link to a data flow stored in a double port memory
(DPRAM).
The USB controller requires a 48 MHz reference clock, which is the output of the
AT8xC5122D/23 PLL (see Section "Phase Lock Loop (PLL)", page 42) divided by a
clock prescaler. This clock is used to generate a 12 MHz full speed bit clock from the
received USB differential data and to transmit data according to full speed USB device
tolerance. Clock recovery is done by a Digital Phase Locked Loop (DPLL) block, which
is compliant with the jitter specification of the USB bus.
The Interface Engine (SIE) block performs NRZI encoding and decoding, bit stuffing,
CRC generation and checking, and the serial-parallel data conversion. The Universal
Function Interface (UFI) performs the interface between the data flow and the Dual Port
Ram
Figure 49. USB Device Controller Block Diagram
48 MHz +/- 0.25%
DPLL 12MHz
C51
Microcontroller
D+
D-
Interface
USB
D+/D-
Buffer
UFI
Up to 48 MHz
UC_SYSCLK
SIE
Serial Interface Engine (SIE)
The SIE performs the following functions:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
NRZI data encoding and decoding.
Bit stuffing and unstuffing.
CRC generation and checking.
Handshakes.
TOKEN type identifying.
Address checking.
Clock generation (via DPLL).
96
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 50. SIE Block Diagram
End of Packet
Detection
SYNC detection
PID decoder
Start of Packet
Detection
D+
D-
NRZI ‘ NRZ
Bit Unstuffing
Packet bit counter
DataOut
8
Address Decoder
Serial to Parallel
Conversion
Clock
Recovery
SysClk
(12 MHz)
CRC5 & CRC16
Generation/Check
Clk48
(48 MHz)
USB Pattern Generator
Parallel to Serial Converter
Bit Stuffing
8
DataIn [7:0]
NRZI Converter
CRC16 Generator
Function Interface Unit (UFI)
The Function Interface Unit provides the interface between the AT8xC5122D (or
AT83C5123) and the SIE. It manages transactions at the packet level with minimal inter-
vention from the device firmware, which reads and writes the endpoint FIFOs.
Figure 51. UFI Block Diagram
UFI
C51
Microcontroller
Interface
Asynchronous Information
Transfer
DPLL
CSREG 0 to 7
Transfer
Control
FSM
Endpoint 6
Endpoint 5
Registers
Bank
Endpoint 4
Endpoint 3
Endpoint 2
Endpoint 1
Endpoint 0
DPR Control
USB side
DPR Control
mP side
SIE
Up to 48 MHz
UC_SYSCLK
User DPRAM
97
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 52. Minimum Intervention from the USB Device Firmware
OUT Transactions:
OUT DATA0 (n Bytes)
OUT DATA1
ACK interrupt C51
OUT DATA1
HOST
UFI
C51
NACK
ACK
Endpoint FIFO read (n bytes)
IN Transactions:
IN
IN
IN
ACK
HOST
DATA1
DATA1
NACK
Endpoint FIFO write
UFI
interrupt C51
Endpoint FIFO write
C51
98
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Configuration
General Configuration
•
USB controller enable
Before any USB transaction, the 48 MHz required by the USB controller must be cor-
rectly generated (Section "Clock Controller", page 41).
The USB controller should be then enabled by setting the USBE bit in the USBCON
register.
•
Set address
After a Reset or a USB reset, the software has to set the FEN (Function Enable) bit in
the USBADDR register. This action will allow the USB controller to answer to the
requests sent at the address 0.
When a SET_ADDRESS request has been received, the USB controller must only
answer to the address defined by the request. The new address should be stored in the
USBADDR register. The FEN bit and the FADDEN bit in the USBCON register should
be set to allow the USB controller to answer only to requests sent at the new address.
•
Set configuration
The CONFG bit in the USBCON register should be set after a SET_CONFIGURATION
request with a non-zero value. Otherwise, this bit should be cleared.
Endpoint Configuration
•
Selection of an Endpoint
The endpoint register access is performed using the UEPNUM register. The following
registers
correspond to the endpoint whose number is stored in the UEPNUM register. To select
an Endpoint, the firmware has to write the endpoint number in the UEPNUM register.
–
–
–
–
UEPSTAX,
UEPCONX,
UEPDATX,
UBYCTX,
Figure 53. Endpoint Selection
UEPSTA0
UEPCON0
UBYCT0
UEPDAT0
0
Endpoint 0
SFR Registers
1
2
3
4
5
UEPSTAX
UEPCONX
UBYCTX
UEPDATX
X
6
UEPSTA6
UEPCON6
UBYCT6
UEPDAT6
Endpoint 6
UEPNUM
99
4202D–SCR–06/05
•
Endpoint enable
Before using an endpoint, this one should be enabled by setting the EPEN bit in the
UEPCONX register.
An endpoint which is not enabled won’t answer to any USB request. The Default Control
Endpoint (Endpoint 0) should always be enabled in order to answer to USB standard
requests.
•
Endpoint type configuration
All Standard Endpoints can be configured in Control, Bulk, Interrupt or Isochronous
mode. The Ping-pong Endpoints can be configured in Bulk, Interrupt or Isochronous
mode. The configuration of an endpoint is performed by setting the field EPTYPE with
the following values:
–
–
–
–
Control:
Isochronous: EPTYPE = 01b
Bulk:
Interrupt:
EPTYPE = 00b
EPTYPE = 10b
EPTYPE = 11b
The Endpoint 0 is the Default Control Endpoint and should always be configured in Con-
trol type.
•
Endpoint direction configuration
For Bulk, Interrupt and Isochronous endpoints, the direction is defined with the EPDIR
bit of the UEPCONX register with the following values:
–
–
IN:EPDIR = 1b
OUT:EPDIR = 0b
For Control endpoints, the EPDIR bit has no effect.
•
Summary of Endpoint Configuration:
Make sure to select the correct endpoint number in the UEPNUM register before
accessing to endpoint specific registers.
Table 62. Summary of Endpoint Configuration
Endpoint configuration
EPEN
EPDIR
Xb
EPTYPE
XXb
00b
UEPCONX
0XXX XXXb
80h
Disabled
0b
Control
1b
Xb
Bulk-In
1b
1b
10b
86h
Bulk-Out
1b
0b
10b
82h
Interrupt-In
1b
1b
11b
87h
Interrupt-Out
Isochronous-In
Isochronous-Out
1b
0b
11b
83h
1b
1b
01b
85h
1b
0b
01b
81h
100
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
•
Endpoint FIFO reset
Before using an endpoint, its FIFO should be reset. This action resets the FIFO pointer
to its original value, resets the byte counter of the endpoint (UBYCTX register), and
resets the data toggle bit (DTGL bit in UEPCONX).
The reset of an endpoint FIFO is performed by setting to 1 and resetting to 0 the corre-
sponding bit in the UEPRST register.
For example, in order to reset the Endpoint number 2 FIFO, write 0000 0100b then 0000
0000b in the UEPRST register.
101
4202D–SCR–06/05
Read/Write Data FIFO
Read Data FIFO
The read access for each OUT endpoint is performed using the UEPDATX register.
After a new valid packet has been received on an Endpoint, the data are stored into the
FIFO and the byte counter of the endpoint is updated (UBYCTX register). The firmware
has to store the endpoint byte counter before any access to the endpoint FIFO. The byte
counter is not updated when reading the FIFO.
To read data from an endpoint, select the correct endpoint number in UEPNUM and
read the UEPDATX register. This action automatically decreases the corresponding
address vector, and the next data is then available in the UEPDATX register.
Write Data FIFO
The write access for each IN endpoint is performed using the UEPDATX register.
To write a byte into an IN endpoint FIFO, select the correct endpoint number in UEP-
NUM and write into the UEPDATX register. The corresponding address vector is
automatically increased, and another write can be carried out.
Warning 1: The byte counter is not updated.
Warning 2: Do not write more bytes than supported by the corresponding endpoint.
Figure 54. Endpoint FIFO Configuration
138H
Endpoint 6 - bank 1
F8H
B8H
78H
2 x 64 Bytes
64 Bytes
Endpoint 6 - bank 0
Endpoint 5 - bank 0
Endpoint 4 - bank 0
64 Bytes
8 Bytes
8 Bytes
8 Bytes
32 Bytes
38H
30H
28H
20H
00H
Endpoint 3 - bank 0
Endpoint 2 - bank 0
Endpoint 1 - bank 0
Endpoint 0 - bank 0
102
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Bulk / Interrupt
Transactions
Bulk and Interrupt transactions are managed in the same way.
Bulk/Interrupt OUT
Transactions in Standard
Mode
Figure 55. Bulk/Interrupt OUT transactions in Standard Mode
UFI
C51
HOST
OUT DATA0 (n bytes)
ACK
RXOUTB0
Endpoint FIFO read byte 1
Endpoint FIFO read byte 2
OUT DATA1
OUT DATA1
NAK
NAK
Endpoint FIFO read byte n
Clear RXOUTB0
DATA1
OUT
ACK
RXOUTB0
Endpoint FIFO read byte 1
An endpoint should be first enabled and configured before being able to receive Bulk or
Interrupt packets.
When a valid OUT packet is received on an endpoint, the RXOUTB0 bit is set by the
USB controller. This triggers an interrupt if enabled. The firmware has to select the cor-
responding endpoint, store the number of data bytes by reading the UBYCTX register. If
the received packet is a ZLP (Zero Length Packet), the UBYCTX register value is equal
to 0 and no data has to be read.
When all the endpoint FIFO bytes have been read, the firmware should clear the
RXOUTB0 bit to allow the USB controller to accept the next OUT packet on this end-
point. Until the RXOUTB0 bit has been cleared by the firmware, the USB controller will
answer a NAK handshake for each OUT requests.
If the Host sends more bytes than supported by the endpoint FIFO, the overflow data
won’t be stored, but the USB controller will consider that the packet is valid if the CRC is
correct and the endpoint byte counter contains the number of bytes sent by the Host.
103
4202D–SCR–06/05
Bulk/Interrupt OUT
Figure 56. Bulk / Interrupt OUT Transactions in Ping-Pong Mode
Transactions in Ping-Pong
Mode (Endpoints 6)
UFI
C51
HOST
OUT DATA0 (n bytes)
ACK
RXOUTB0
Endpoint FIFO bank 0 - read byte 1
Endpoint FIFO bank 0 - read byte 2
DATA1 (m bytes)
OUT
ACK
ACK
Endpoint FIFO bank 0 - read byte n
Clear RXOUTB0
RXOUTB1
RXOUTB0
OUT DATA0 (p bytes)
Endpoint FIFO bank 1 - read byte 1
Endpoint FIFO bank 1 - read byte 2
Endpoint FIFO bank 1 - read byte m
Clear RXOUTB1
Endpoint FIFO bank 0 - read byte 1
Endpoint FIFO bank 0 - read byte 2
Endpoint FIFO bank 0 - read byte p
Clear RXOUTB0
An endpoint should be first enabled and configured before being able to receive Bulk or
Interrupt packets.
When a valid OUT packet is received on the endpoint bank 0, the RXOUTB0 bit is set by
the USB controller. This triggers an interrupt if enabled. The firmware has to select the
corresponding endpoint, store the number of data bytes by reading the UBYCTX regis-
ter. If the received packet is a ZLP (Zero Length Packet), the UBYCTX register value is
equal to 0 and no data has to be read.
When all the endpoint FIFO bytes have been read, the firmware should clear the
RXOUB0 bit to allow the USB controller to accept the next OUT packet on the endpoint
bank 0. This action switches the endpoint bank 0 and 1. Until the RXOUTB0 bit has
been cleared by the firmware, the USB controller will answer a NAK handshake for each
OUT requests on the bank 0 endpoint FIFO.
When a new valid OUT packet is received on the endpoint bank 1, the RXOUTB1 bit is
set by the USB controller. This triggers an interrupt if enabled. The firmware empties the
bank 1 endpoint FIFO before clearing the RXOUTB1 bit. Until the RXOUTB1 bit has
been cleared by the firmware, the USB controller will answer a NAK handshake for each
OUT requests on the bank 1 endpoint FIFO.
The RXOUTB0 and RXOUTB1 bits are alternatively set by the USB controller at each
new valid packet receipt.
The firmware has to clear one of these two bits after having read all the data FIFO to
allow a new valid packet to be stored in the corresponding bank.
A NAK handshake is sent by the USB controller only if the banks 0 and 1 has not been
released by the firmware.
104
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
If the Host sends more bytes than supported by the endpoint FIFO, the overflow data
won’t be stored, but the USB controller will consider that the packet is valid if the CRC is
correct.
Bulk/Interrupt IN Transactions Figure 57. Bulk/Interrupt IN Transactions in Standard Mode
In Standard Mode
HOST
UFI
C51
Endpoint FIFO write byte 1
IN
Endpoint FIFO write byte 2
NAK
Endpoint FIFO write byte n
Set TXRDY
IN
DATA0 (n bytes)
TXCMPL
ACK
Clear TXCMPL
Endpoint FIFO write byte 1
An endpoint should be first enabled and configured before being able to send Bulk or
Interrupt packets.
The firmware should fill the FIFO with the data to be sent and set the TXRDY bit in the
UEPSTAX register to allow the USB controller to send the data stored in FIFO at the
next IN request concerning this endpoint. To send a Zero Length Packet, the firmware
should set the TXRDY bit without writing any data into the endpoint FIFO.
Until the TXRDY bit has been set by the firmware, the USB controller will answer a NAK
handshake for each IN requests.
To cancel the sending of this packet, the firmware has to reset the TXRDY bit. The
packet stored in the endpoint FIFO is then cleared and a new packet can be written and
sent.
When the IN packet has been sent and acknowledged by the Host, the TXCMPL bit in
the UEPSTAX register is set by the USB controller. This triggers a USB interrupt if
enabled. The firmware should clear the TXCMPL bit before filling the endpoint FIFO with
new data.
The firmware should never write more bytes than supported by the endpoint FIFO.
All USB retry mechanisms are automatically managed by the USB controller.
105
4202D–SCR–06/05
Bulk/Interrupt IN Transactions Figure 58. Bulk / Interrupt IN transactions in Ping-Pong mode
in Ping-Pong Mode
HOST
UFI
C51
Endpoint FIFO Bank 0 - Write Byte 1
IN
Endpoint FIFO Bank 0 - Write Byte 2
NACK
Endpoint FIFO Bank 0 - Write Byte n
Set TXRDY
IN
Endpoint FIFO Bank 1 - Write Byte 1
Endpoint FIFO Bank 1 - Write Byte 2
DATA0 (n Bytes)
ACK
Endpoint FIFO Bank 1 - Write Byte m
Clear TXCMPL
TXCMPL
Set TXRDY
IN
IN
Endpoint FIFO Bank 0 - Write Byte 1
Endpoint FIFO Bank 0 - Write Byte 2
DATA1 (m Bytes)
ACK
Endpoint FIFO Bank 0 - Write Byte p
Clear TXCMPL
TXCMPL
Set TXRDY
Endpoint FIFO Bank 1 - Write Byte 1
DATA0 (p Bytes)
ACK
An endpoint will be first enabled and configured before being able to send Bulk or Inter-
rupt packets.
The firmware will fill the FIFO bank 0 with the data to be sent and set the TXRDY bit in
the UEPSTAX register to allow the USB controller to send the data stored in FIFO at the
next IN request concerning the endpoint. The FIFO banks are automatically switched,
and the firmware can immediately write into the endpoint FIFO bank 1.
When the IN packet concerning the bank 0 has been sent and acknowledged by the
Host, the TXCMPL bit is set by the USB controller. This triggers a USB interrupt if
enabled. The firmware will clear the TXCMPL bit before filling the endpoint FIFO bank 0
with new data. The FIFO banks are then automatically switched.
When the IN packet concerning the bank 1 has been sent and acknowledged by the
Host, the TXCMPL bit is set by the USB controller. This triggers a USB interrupt if
enabled. The firmware will clear the TXCMPL bit before filling the endpoint FIFO bank 1
with new data.
The bank switch is performed by the USB controller each time the TXRDY bit is set by
the firmware. Until the TXRDY bit has been set by the firmware for an endpoint bank,
the USB controller will answer a NAK handshake for each IN requests concerning this
bank.
Note that in the example above, the firmware clears the Transmit Complete bit (TXC-
MPL) before setting the Transmit Ready bit (TXRDY). This is done in order to avoid the
firmware to clear at the same time the TXCMPL bit for bank 0 and the bank 1.
The firmware will never write more bytes than supported by the endpoint FIFO.
106
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Control Transactions
Setup Stage
The DIR bit in the UEPSTAX register should be at 0.
Receiving Setup packets is the same as receiving Bulk Out packets, except that the
Rxsetup bit in the UEPSTAX register is set by the USB controller instead of the
RXOUTB0 bit to indicate that an Out packet with a Setup PID has been received on the
Control endpoint. When the RXSETUP bit has been set, all the other bits of the UEP-
STAX register are cleared and an interrupt is triggered if enabled.
The firmware has to read the Setup request stored in the Control endpoint FIFO before
clearing the RXSETUP bit to free the endpoint FIFO for the next transaction.
Data Stage: Control Endpoint The data stage management is similar to Bulk management.
Direction
A Control endpoint is managed by the USB controller as a full-duplex endpoint: IN and
OUT. All other endpoint types are managed as half-duplex endpoint: IN or OUT. The
firmware has to specify the control endpoint direction for the data stage using the DIR bit
in the UEPSTAX register.
•
If the data stage consists of INs,
the firmware has to set the DIR bit in the UEPSTAX register before writing into the
FIFO and sending the data by setting to 1 the TXRDY bit in the UEPSTAX register.
The IN transaction is complete when the TXCMPL has been set by the hardware.
The firmware should clear the TXCMPL bit before any other transaction.
•
If the data stage consists of OUTs,
the firmware has to leave the DIR bit at 0. The RXOUTB0 bit is set by hardware
when a new valid packet has been received on the endpoint. The firmware must
read the data stored into the FIFO and then clear the RXOUTB0 bit to reset the
FIFO and to allow the next transaction.
The bit DIR is used to send the correct data toggle in the data stage.
To send a STALL handshake, see “STALL Handshake” on page 110.
Status Stage
The DIR bit in the UEPSTAX register should be reset at 0 for IN and OUT status stage.
The status stage management is similar to Bulk management.
•
For a Control Write transaction or a No-Data Control transaction, the status stage
consists of a IN Zero Length Packet (see “Bulk/Interrupt IN Transactions In
Standard Mode” on page 105). To send a STALL handshake, see “STALL
Handshake” on page 110.
•
For a Control Read transaction, the status stage consists of a OUT Zero Length
Packet (see “Bulk/Interrupt OUT Transactions in Standard Mode” on page 103).
107
4202D–SCR–06/05
Isochronous
Transactions
Isochronous OUT
Transactions in Standard
Mode
An endpoint should be first enabled and configured before being able to receive Isochro-
nous packets.
When an OUT packet is received on an endpoint, the RXOUTB0 bit is set by the USB
controller. This triggers an interrupt if enabled. The firmware has to select the corre-
sponding endpoint, store the number of data bytes by reading the UBYCTX register. If
the received packet is a ZLP (Zero Length Packet), the UBYCTX register value is equal
to 0 and no data has to be read.
The STLCRC bit in the UEPSTAX register is set by the USB controller if the packet
stored in FIFO has a corrupted CRC. This bit is updated after each new packet receipt.
When all the endpoint FIFO bytes have been read, the firmware should clear the
RXOUTB0 bit to allow the USB controller to store the next OUT packet data into the
endpoint FIFO. Until the RXOUTB0 bit has been cleared by the firmware, the data sent
by the Host at each OUT transaction will be lost.
If the RXOUTB0 bit is cleared while the Host is sending data, the USB controller will
store only the remaining bytes into the FIFO.
If the Host sends more bytes than supported by the endpoint FIFO, the overflow data
won’t be stored, but the USB controller will consider that the packet is valid if the CRC is
correct.
Isochronous OUT
Transactions in Ping-pong
Mode
An endpoint should be first enabled and configured before being able to receive Isochro-
nous packets.
When a OUT packet is received on the endpoint bank 0, the RXOUTB0 bit is set by the
USB controller. This triggers an interrupt if enabled. The firmware has to select the cor-
responding endpoint, store the number of data bytes by reading the UBYCTX register. If
the received packet is a ZLP (Zero Length Packet), the UBYCTX register value is equal
to 0 and no data has to be read.
The STLCRC bit in the UEPSTAX register is set by the USB controller if the packet
stored in FIFO has a corrupted CRC. This bit is updated after each new packet receipt.
When all the endpoint FIFO bytes have been read, the firmware should clear the
RXOUB0 bit to allow the USB controller to store the next OUT packet data into the end-
point FIFO bank 0. This action switches the endpoint bank 0 and 1. Until the RXOUTB0
bit has been cleared by the firmware, the data sent by the Host on the bank 0 endpoint
FIFO will be lost.
If the RXOUTB0 bit is cleared while the Host is sending data on the endpoint bank 0, the
USB controller will store only the remaining bytes into the FIFO.
When a new OUT packet is received on the endpoint bank 1, the RXOUTB1 bit is set by
the USB controller. This triggers an interrupt if enabled. The firmware empties the
bank 1 endpoint FIFO before clearing the RXOUTB1 bit. Until the RXOUTB1 bit has
been cleared by the firmware, the data sent by the Host on the bank 1 endpoint FIFO
will be lost.
The RXOUTB0 and RXOUTB1 bits are alternatively set by the USB controller at each
new packet receipt.
The firmware has to clear one of these two bits after having read all the data FIFO to
allow a new packet to be stored in the corresponding bank.
108
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
If the Host sends more bytes than supported by the endpoint FIFO, the overflow data
won’t be stored, but the USB controller will consider that the packet is valid if the CRC is
correct.
Isochronous IN Transactions
in Standard Mode
An endpoint should be first enabled and configured before being able to send Isochro-
nous packets.
The firmware should fill the FIFO with the data to be sent and set the TXRDY bit in the
UEPSTAX register to allow the USB controller to send the data stored in FIFO at the
next IN request concerning this endpoint.
If the TXRDY bit is not set when the IN request occurs, nothing will be sent by the USB
controller.
When the IN packet has been sent, the TXCMPL bit in the UEPSTAX register is set by
the USB controller. This triggers a USB interrupt if enabled. The firmware should clear
the TXCMPL bit before filling the endpoint FIFO with new data. The firmware should
never write more bytes than supported by the endpoint FIFO.
Isochronous IN Transactions
in Ping-Pong Mode
An endpoint should be first enabled and configured before being able to send Isochro-
nous packets.
The firmware should fill the FIFO bank 0 with the data to be sent and set the TXRDY bit
in the UEPSTAX register to allow the USB controller to send the data stored in FIFO at
the next IN request concerning the endpoint. The FIFO banks are automatically
switched, and the firmware can immediately write into the endpoint FIFO bank 1.
If the TXRDY bit is not set when the IN request occurs, nothing will be sent by the USB
controller.
When the IN packet concerning the bank 0 has been sent, the TXCMPL bit is set by the
USB controller. This triggers a USB interrupt if enabled. The firmware should clear the
TXCMPL bit before filling the endpoint FIFO bank 0 with new data. The FIFO banks are
then automatically switched.
When the IN packet concerning the bank 1 has been sent, the TXCMPL bit is set by the
USB controller. This triggers a USB interrupt if enabled. The firmware should clear the
TXCMPL bit before filling the endpoint FIFO bank 1 with new data.
The bank switch is performed by the USB controller each time the TXRDY bit is set by
the firmware. Until the TXRDY bit has been set by the firmware for an endpoint bank,
the USB controller won’t send anything at each IN requests concerning this bank.
The firmware should never write more bytes than supported by the endpoint FIFO.
109
4202D–SCR–06/05
Miscellaneous
USB Reset
The EORINT bit in the USBINT register is set by hardware when a End of Reset has
been detected on the USB bus. This triggers a USB interrupt if enabled. The USB con-
troller is still enabled, but all the USB registers are reset by hardware. The firmware
should clear the EORINT bit to allow the next USB reset detection.
STALL Handshake
This function is only available for Control, Bulk, and Interrupt endpoints.
The firmware has to set the STALLRQ bit in the UEPSTAX register to send a STALL
handshake at the next request of the Host on the endpoint selected with the UEPNUM
register. The RXSETUP, TXRDY, TXCMPL, RXOUTB0 and RXOUTB1 bits must be first
reset to 0. The bit STLCRC is set at 1 by the USB controller when a STALL has been
sent. This triggers an interrupt if enabled.
The firmware should clear the STALLRQ and STLCRC bits after each STALL sent.
The STALLRQ bit is cleared automatically by hardware when a valid SETUP PID is
received on a CONTROL type endpoint.
Start of Frame Detection
Frame Number
The SOFINT bit in the USBINT register is set when the USB controller detects a Start Of
Frame PID. This triggers an interrupt if enabled. The firmware should clear the SOFINT
bit to allow the next Start of Frame detection.
When receiving a Start of Frame, the frame number is automatically stored in the
UFNUML and UFNUMH registers. The CRCOK and CRCERR bits indicate if the CRC of
the last Start Of Frame is valid (CRCOK set at 1) or corrupt (CRCERR set at 1). The
UFNUML and UFNUMH registers are automatically updated when receiving a new Start
of Frame.
Data Toggle Bit
The Data Toggle bit is set by hardware when a DATA 0 packet is received and accepted
by the USB controller and cleared by hardware when a DATA 1 packet is received and
accepted by the USB controller. This bit is reset when the firmware resets the endpoint
FIFO using the UEPRST register.
For Control endpoints, each SETUP transaction starts with a DATA 0 and data toggling
is then used as for Bulk endpoints until the end of the Data stage (for a control write
transfer). The Status stage completes the data transfer with a DATA 1 (for a control read
transfer).
For Isochronous endpoints, the device firmware should ignore the data-toggle.
NAK Handshakes
When a NAK handshake is sent by the USB controller to a IN or OUT request from the
Host, the NAKIN or NAKOUT bit is set by hardware. This information can be used to
determine the direction of the communication during a Control transfer.
These bits are cleared by software.
110
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Suspend/Resume Management
Suspend
The Suspend state can be detected by the USB controller if all the clocks are enabled
and if the USB controller is enabled. The bit SPINT is set by hardware when an idle
state is detected for more than 3 ms. This triggers a USB interrupt if enabled.
In order to reduce current consumption, the firmware can put the USB PAD in idle mode,
stop the clocks and put the C51 in Idle or Power-down mode. The Resume detection is
still active.
The USB PAD is put in idle mode when the firmware clear the SPINT bit. In order to
avoid a new suspend detection 3ms later, the firmware has to disable the USB clock
input using the SUSPCLK bit in the USBCON Register. The USB PAD automatically
exits of idle mode when a wake-up event is detected.
The stop of the 48 MHz clock from the PLL should be done in the following order:
1. Disable of the 48 MHz clock input of the USB controller by setting to 1 the SUS-
PCLK bit in the USBCON register.
2. Disable the PLL by clearing the PLLEN bit in the PLLCON register.
Resume
When the USB controller is in Suspend state, the Resume detection is active even if all
the clocks are disabled and if the C51 is in Idle or Power-down mode. The WUPCPU bit
is set by hardware when a non-idle state occurs on the USB bus. This triggers an inter-
rupt if enabled. This interrupt wakes up the CPU from its Idle or Power-down state and
the interrupt function is then executed. The firmware will first enable the 48 MHz gener-
ation and then reset to 0 the SUSPCLK bit in the USBCON register if needed.
The firmware has to clear the SPINT bit in the USBINT register before any other USB
operation in order to wake up the USB controller from its Suspend mode.
The USB controller is then re-activated.
111
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 59. Example of a Suspend/Resume Management
USB Controller Init
SPINT
Detection of a SUSPEND State
Put the USB pads
Clear SPINT
in power down mode
Set SUSPCLK
Disable PLL
microcontroller in power-down
WUPCPU
Detection of a RESUME State
Clear SUSPCLK
Note :
WUPCPU bit must be
Cleared before enabling
the PLL
Clear WUPCPU bit
Enable PLL
Upstream Resume
A USB device can be allowed by the Host to send an upstream resume for Remote
Wake-up purpose.
When the USB controller receives the SET_FEATURE request:
DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP, the firmware should set to 1 the RMWUPE bit in the
USBCON register to enable this function. RMWUPE value should be 0 in the other
cases.
If the device is in SUSPEND mode, the USB controller can send an upstream resume by
clearing first the SPINT bit in the USBINT register and by setting then to 1 the SDRM-
WUP bit in the USBCON register. The USB controller sets to 1 the UPRSM bit in the
USBCON register. All clocks must be enabled first. The Remote Wake is sent only if the
USB bus was in Suspend state for at least 5 ms. When the upstream resume is com-
pleted, the UPRSM bit is reset to 0 by hardware. The firmware should then clear the
SDRMWUP bit.
112
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 60. Example of REMOTE WAKEUP Management
USB Controller Init
SET_FEATURE: DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP
Set RMWUPE
SPINT
Detection of a SUSPEND state
Suspend management
Need USB Resume
Enable Clocks
Clear SPINT
UPRSM = 1
Set SDMWUP
UPRSM
upstream RESUME sent
Clear SDRMWUP
113
4202D–SCR–06/05
Detach Simulation
In order to be re-enumerated by the Host, the AT8xC5122/23 has the possibility to sim-
ulate a DETACH-ATTACH of the USB bus.
The VREF output voltage is between 3.0V and 3.6V. This output can be connected to the
D+ pull-up as shown in Figure 61. This output can be put in high-impedance when the
DETACH bit is set to 1 in the USBCON register. Maintaining this output in high imped-
ance for more than 3 µs will simulate the disconnection of the device. When resetting
the DETACH bit, an ATTACH is then simulated. The USB controller should be enabled
to use this feature.
Figure 61. Example of VREF Connection
VREF
R1
1
R2
VCC
D-
D+
GND
USB-B Connector
2
3
4
D-
D+
R3
Figure 62. Disconnect Timing
D+
VIHZ(min)
VIL
D-
VSS
>= 2,5 µs
Disconnect
Detected
Device
Disconnected
114
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
USB Interrupt System
Interrupt System Priorities
Figure 63. USB Interrupt Control System
00
01
10
11
D+
USB
Controller
D-
EUSB
EA
IPH/L
Priority Enable
IEN1.6
IEN0.7
Interrupt Enable
Lowest Priority Interrupts
Table 63. Priority Levels
IPHUSB
IPLUSB
USB Priority Level
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0 Lowest
1
2
3 Highest
Interrupt Control System
As shown in Figure 64, many events can produce a USB interrupt:
•
•
•
TXCMPL: Transmitted In Data (Table 70 on page 121). This bit is set by hardware
when the Host accept a In packet.
RXOUTB0: Received Out Data Bank 0 (Table 70 on page 121). This bit is set by
hardware when an Out packet is accepted by the endpoint and stored in bank 0.
RXOUTB1: Received Out Data Bank 1 (only for Ping-Pong endpoints) (Table 70 on
page 121). This bit is set by hardware when an Out packet is accepted by the
endpoint and stored in bank 1.
•
•
•
RXSETUP: Received Setup (Table 70 on page 121). This bit is set by hardware
when an SETUP packet is accepted by the endpoint.
NAKIN and NAKOUT: These bits are set by hardware when a Nak Handshake has
been received on the corresponding endpoint. These bits are cleared by software.
STLCRC: STALLED (only for Control, Bulk and Interrupt endpoints) (Table on page
122). This bit is set by hardware when a STALL handshake has been sent as
requested by STALLRQ, and is reset by hardware when a SETUP packet is
received.
•
•
•
SOFINT: Start Of Frame Interrupt (Table 65 on page 118). This bit is set by
hardware when a USB start of frame packet has been received.
WUPCPU: Wake-Up CPU Interrupt (Table 65 on page 118). This bit is set by
hardware when a USB resume is detected on the USB bus, after a SUSPEND state.
SPINT: Suspend Interrupt (Table 65 on page 118). This bit is set by hardware when
a USB suspend is detected on the USB bus.
115
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 64. USB Interrupt Control Block Diagram
Endpoint X (X = 0..6)
TXCMP
UEPSTAX.0
RXOUTB0
UEPSTAX.1
RXOUTB1
EPXINT
UEPSTAX.6
UEPINT.X
RXSETUP
EPXIE
UEPSTAX.2
UEPIEN.X
STLCRC
UEPSTAX.3
NAKOUT
UEPCONX.5
NAKIN
UEPCONX.4
NAKIEN
UEPCONX.6
WUPCPU
USBINT.5
EUSB
IE1.6
EWUPCPU
USBIEN.5
EORINT
USBINT.4
EEORINT
USBIEN.4
SOFINT
USBINT.3
ESOFINT
USBIEN.3
SPINT
USBINT.0
ESPINT
USBIEN.0
116
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Registers
Table 64. USB Global Control Register - USBCON (S:BCh)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
USBE
SUSPCLK SDRMWUP
DETACH
UPRSM
RMWUPE
CONFG
FADDEN
Bit
Bit
Number
Mnemonic Description
USB Enable
Set this bit to enable the USB controller.
7
6
USBE
Clear this bit to disable and reset the USB controller, to disable the USB
transceiver and to disable the USB controller clock inputs.
Suspend USB Clock
SUSPCLK Set this bit to disable the 48MHz clock input (Resume Detection is still active).
Clear this bit to enable the 48MHz clock input.
Send Remote Wake-up
Set this bit to force an external interrupt on the USB controller for Remote Wake
UP purpose.
5
SDRMWUP
An upstream resume is send only if the bit RMWUPE is set, all USB clocks are
enabled AND the USB bus was in SUSPEND state for at least 5 ms. See UPRSM
below. This bit is cleared by software.
Detach Command
Set this bit to simulate a Detach on the USB line. The VREF pin is then in a
4
3
DETACH
floating state.
Clear this bit to maintain VREF at 3.3V.
Upstream Resume (read only)
This bit is set by hardware when SDRMWUP has been set and if RMWUPE is
UPRSM
enabled.
This bit is cleared by hardware after the upstream resume has been sent.
Remote Wake-Up Enable
Set this bit to enabled request an upstream resume signaling to the host.
Clear this bit otherwise.
2
1
RMWUPE
CONFG
Note: Do not set this bit if the host has not set the DEVICE_REMOTE_WAKEUP
feature for the device.
Configured
This bit should be set by the device firmware after a SET_CONFIGURATION
request with a non-zero value has been correctly processed.
It should be cleared by the device firmware when a SET_CONFIGURATION
request with a zero value is received. It is cleared by hardware on hardware reset
or when an USB reset is detected on the bus (SE0 state for at least 32 Full Speed
bit times: typically 2.7 µs).
Function Address Enable
This bit should be set by the device firmware after a successful status phase of a
SET_ADDRESS transaction.
It should not be cleared afterwards by the device firmware. It is cleared by
hardware on hardware reset or when an USB reset is received (see above).
When this bit is cleared, the default function address is used (0).
0
FADDEN
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
117
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 65. USB Global Interrupt Register - USBINT (S:BDh)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
WUPCPU
EORINT
SOFINT
-
-
SPINT
Bit
Bit Number Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7 - 6
-
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not change these bits.
Wake-up CPU Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when the USB controller is in SUSPEND state and is
re-activated by a non-idle signal FROM USB line (not by an upstream resume).
This triggers a USB interrupt when EWUPCPU is set in the Table on page 119.
When receiving this interrupt, user has to enable all USB clock inputs.
5
WUPCPU
This bit should be cleared by software (USB clocks must be enabled before).
End of Reset Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when a End of Reset has been detected by the USB
4
EEORINT controller. This triggers a USB interrupt when EEORINT is set in the Table on
page 119.
This bit should be cleared by software.
Start Of Frame Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when an USB Start Of Frame PID (SOF) has been
SOFINT detected. This triggers a USB interrupt when ESOFINT is set in the Table on
page 119.
3
This bit should be cleared by software.
Reserved
2-1
-
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not change these bits.
Suspend Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when a USB Suspend (Idle bus for three frame
periods: a J state for 3 ms) is detected. This triggers a USB interrupt when
ESPINT is set in USBIEN register (Table 66 on page 119).
0
SPINT
This bit must be cleared by software before powering the microcontroller down
as it disables the USB pads to reduce the power consumption.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
118
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 66. USB Global Interrupt Enable Register - USBIEN (S:BEh)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
EWUPCPU EEORINT
ESOFINT
-
-
ESPINT
Bit
Bit Number Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7 - 6
5
-
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not change these bits.
Enable Wake-up CPU Interrupt
EWUPCPU Set this bit to enable Wake-up CPU Interrupt.
Clear this bit to disable Wake-up CPU Interrupt.
Enable End of Reset Interrupt
4
EEORINT Set this bit to enable End of Reset Interrupt. This bit is set after reset.
Clear this bit to disable End of Reset Interrupt.
Enable SOF Interrupt
3
2-1
0
ESOFINT Set this bit to enable SOF Interrupt.
Clear this bit to disable SOF Interrupt.
Reserved
-
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not change these bits.
Enable Suspend Interrupt
ESPINT Set this bit to enable Suspend Interrupts (See Table 65 on page 118).
Clear this bit to disable Suspend Interrupts.
Reset Value = 0001 0000b
Table 67. USB Address Register - USBADDR (S:C6h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FEN
UADD6
UADD5
UADD4
UADD3
UADD2
UADD1
UADD0
Bit
Bit
Number
Mnemonic Description
Function Enable
7
FEN
Set this bit to enable the function. FADD is reset to 1.
Cleared this bit to disable the function.
USB Address
This field contains the default address (0) after power-up or USB bus reset.
It should be written with the value set by a SET_ADDRESS request received by
the device firmware.
6-0
UADD[6:0]
Reset Value = 1000 0000b
119
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 68. USB Endpoint Number - UEPNUM (S:C7h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
-
EPNUM3
EPNUM2
EPNUM1
EPNUM0
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic
Description
Reserved
7 - 4
-
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not change these bits.
Endpoint Number
Set this field with the number of the endpoint which should be accessed when reading or writing to, USB Byte
Count Register X (X=EPNUM set in UEPNUM Register) - UBYCTX (S:E2h) or USB Endpoint X Control Register -
UEPCONX (S:D4h). This value can be 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 6.
3 - 0
EPNUM[3:0]
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
Table 69. USB Endpoint X Control Register - UEPCONX (S:D4h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EPEN
NAKIEN
NAKOUT
NAKIN
DTGL
EPDIR
EPTYPE1
EPTYPE0
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic
Description
Endpoint Enable
Set this bit to enable the endpoint according to the device configuration. Endpoint 0 will always be enabled after
a hardware or USB bus reset and participate in the device configuration.
Clear this bit to disable the endpoint according to the device configuration.
7
EPEN
NAK Interrupt Enable
6
5
NAKIEN
Set this bit to enable NAKIN and NAKOUT Interrupt.
Clear this bit to disable NAKIN and NAKOUT Interrupt.
NAK OUT Sent
This bit is set by hardware when the a NAK handshake is sent by the USB controller to an OUT request from
the Host. This generates an interrupt if the NAKIEN bit is set.
This bit shall be cleared by software.
NAKOUT
NAK IN Sent
This bit is set by hardware when the a NAK handshake is sent by the USB controller to an IN request from the
Host. This generates an interrupt if the NAKIEN bit is set.
4
3
2
NAKIN
DTGL
EPDIR
This bit shall be cleared by software.
Data Toggle (Read-only)
This bit is set by hardware when a valid DATA0 packet is received and accepted.
This bit is cleared by hardware when a valid DATA1 packet is received and accepted.
Endpoint Direction
Set this bit to configure IN direction for Bulk, Interrupt and Isochronous endpoints.
Clear this bit to configure OUT direction for Bulk, Interrupt and Isochronous endpoints.
This bit has no effect for Control endpoints.
Endpoint Type
Set this field according to the endpoint configuration (Endpoint 0 will always be configured as control):
00Control endpoint
01Isochronous endpoint
10Bulk endpoint
1-0
EPTYPE[1:0]
11Interrupt endpoint
Reset Value = 1000 0000b when UEPNUM = 0
Reset Value = 0000 0000b otherwise
120
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 70. USB Endpoint Status and Control Register X - UEPSTAX (S:CEh) X=EPNUM set in UEPNUM Register)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DIR
RXOUTB1
STALLRQ
TXRDY
STL/CRC
RXSETUP
RXOUTB0
TXCMP
Bit
Bit
Number Mnemonic Description
Control Endpoint Direction
This bit is used only if the endpoint is configured in the control type (see“USB Endpoint X Control Register - UEPCONX (S:D4h)”
on page 120).
7
DIR
This bit determines the Control data and status direction.
The device firmware should set this bit ONLY for the IN data stage, before any other USB operation. Otherwise, the device
firmware should clear this bit.
Received OUT Data Bank 1 for Endpoint 6 (Ping-pong Mode)
This bit is set by hardware after a new packet has been stored in the endpoint FIFO Data bank 1 (only in Ping-pong mode).
Then, the endpoint interrupt is triggered if enabled (see “USB Global Interrupt Register - USBINT (S:BDh)” on page 118) and all
the following OUT packets to the endpoint bank 1 are rejected (NAK’ed) until this bit has been cleared, excepted for Isochronous
Endpoints.
6
5
4
RXOUTB1
STALLRQ
TXRDY
This bit should be cleared by the device firmware after reading the OUT data from the endpoint FIFO.
Stall Handshake Request
Set this bit to request a STALL answer to the host for the next handshake.
Clear this bit otherwise.
For CONTROL endpoints: cleared by hardware when a valid SETUP PID is received.
TX Packet Ready
Set this bit after a packet has been written into the endpoint FIFO for IN data transfers. Data should be written into the endpoint
FIFO only after this bit has been cleared. Set this bit without writing data to the endpoint FIFO to send a Zero Length Packet.
This bit is cleared by hardware, as soon as the packet has been sent for Isochronous endpoints, or after the host has
acknowledged the packet for Control, Bulk and Interrupt endpoints. When this bit is cleared, the endpoint interrupt is triggered if
enabled (see Table 65 on page 118).
Stall Sent / CRC error flag
- For Control, Bulk and Interrupt Endpoints:
This bit is set by hardware after a STALL handshake has been sent as requested by STALLRQ. Then, the endpoint interrupt is
triggered if enabled (see“” on page 118)
3
STLCRC
It should be cleared by the device firmware.
- For Isochronous Endpoints (Read-Only):
This bit is set by hardware if the last received data is corrupted (CRC error on data).
This bit is updated by hardware when a new data is received.
Received SETUP
This bit is set by hardware when a valid SETUP packet has been received from the host. Then, all the other bits of the register
are cleared by hardware and the endpoint interrupt is triggered if enabled (see Table 65 on page 118).
It should be cleared by the device firmware after reading the SETUP data from the endpoint FIFO.
2
1
RXSETUP
RXOUTB0
Received OUT Data Bank 0 (see also RXOUTB1 bit for Ping-pong Endpoints)
This bit is set by hardware after a new packet has been stored in the endpoint FIFO data bank 0. Then, the endpoint interrupt is
triggered if enabled (see“” on page 118) and all the following OUT packets to the endpoint bank 0 are rejected (NAK’ed) until this
bit has been cleared, excepted for Isochronous Endpoints. However, for control endpoints, an early SETUP transaction may
overwrite the content of the endpoint FIFO, even if its Data packet is received while this bit is set.
This bit should be cleared by the device firmware after reading the OUT data from the endpoint FIFO.
Transmitted IN Data Complete
This bit is set by hardware after an IN packet has been transmitted for Isochronous endpoints and after it has been accepted
0
TXCMPL (ACK’ed) by the host for Control, Bulk and Interrupt endpoints. Then, the endpoint interrupt is triggered if enabled (see Table
65).
This bit should be cleared by the device firmware before setting TXRDY.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
121
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 71. USB FIFO Data Endpoint X (X=EPNUM set in UEPNUM Register) -
UEPDATX (S:CFh)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FDAT7
FDAT6
FDAT5
FDAT4
FDAT3
FDAT2
FDAT1
FDAT0
Bit
Bit
Number
Mnemonic Description
Endpoint X FIFO data
7 - 0
FDAT[7:0] Data byte to be written to FIFO or data byte to be read from the FIFO, for the
Endpoint X (see EPNUM).
Reset Value = XXXX XXXXb
Table 72. USB Byte Count Register X (X=EPNUM set in UEPNUM Register) - UBYCTX
(S:E2h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
BYCT6
BYCT5
BYCT4
BYCT3
BYCT2
BYCT1
BYCT0
Bit
Bit
Number Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7
-
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not change this bit.
Byte Count LSB
6 - 0
BYCT[6:0] Least Significant Byte of the byte count of a received data packet. This byte count
is equal to the number of data bytes received after the Data PID.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
122
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 73. USB Endpoint FIFO Reset Register - UEPRST (S:D5h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
EP6RST
EP5RST
EP4RST
EP3RST
EP2RST
EP1RST
EP0RST
Bit
Bit
Number Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7
6
-
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not change this bit.
Endpoint 6 FIFO Reset
Set this bit and reset the endpoint FIFO prior to any other operation, upon
hardware reset or when an USB bus reset has been received.
EP6RST
Then, clear this bit to complete the reset operation and start using the FIFO.
Endpoint 5 FIFO Reset
Set this bit and reset the endpoint FIFO prior to any other operation, upon
hardware reset or when an USB bus reset has been received.
Then, clear this bit to complete the reset operation and start using the FIFO.
5
4
3
2
1
0
EP5RST
EP4RST
EP3RST
EP2RST
EP1RST
EP0RST
Endpoint 4 FIFO Reset
Set this bit and reset the endpoint FIFO prior to any other operation, upon
hardware reset or when an USB bus reset has been received.
Then, clear this bit to complete the reset operation and start using the FIFO.
Endpoint 3 FIFO Reset
Set this bit and reset the endpoint FIFO prior to any other operation, upon
hardware reset or when an USB bus reset has been received.
Then, clear this bit to complete the reset operation and start using the FIFO.
Endpoint 2 FIFO Reset
Set this bit and reset the endpoint FIFO prior to any other operation, upon
hardware reset or when an USB bus reset has been received.
Then, clear this bit to complete the reset operation and start using the FIFO.
Endpoint 1 FIFO Reset
Set this bit and reset the endpoint FIFO prior to any other operation, upon
hardware reset or when an USB bus reset has been received.
Then, clear this bit to complete the reset operation and start using the FIFO.
Endpoint 0 FIFO Reset
Set this bit and reset the endpoint FIFO prior to any other operation, upon
hardware reset or when an USB bus reset has been received.
Then, clear this bit to complete the reset operation and start using the FIFO.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
123
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 74. USB Endpoint Interrupt Register - UEPINT (S:F8h read-only)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
EP6INT
EP5INT
EP4INT
EP3INT
EP2INT
EP1INT
EP0INT
Bit
Bit
Number Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7
6
-
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not change this bit.
Endpoint 6 Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when an interrupt has been detected on the endpoint 6.
The interrupt sources are part of UEPSTAX register and can be : TXCMP,
RXOUTB0, RXOUTB1, RXSETUP or STLCRC. A USB interrupt is triggered when
the EP6INTE bit in the UEPIEN register is set.
EP6INT
This bit is cleared by hardware when all the interrupt sources are cleared.
Endpoint 5 Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when an interrupt has been detected on the endpoint 5.
The interrupt sources are part of UEPSTAX register and can be : TXCMP,
RXOUTB0, RXOUTB1, RXSETUP or STLCRC. A USB interrupt is triggered when
the EP5INTE bit in the UEPIEN register is set.
5
4
3
2
1
0
EP5INT
EP4INT
EP3INT
EP2INT
EP1INT
EP0INT
This bit is cleared by hardware when all the interrupt sources are cleared.
Endpoint 4 Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when an interrupt has been detected on the endpoint 4.
The interrupt sources are part of UEPSTAX register and can be : TXCMP,
RXOUTB0, RXOUTB1, RXSETUP or STLCRC. A USB interrupt is triggered when
the EP4INTE bit in the UEPIEN register is set.
This bit is cleared by hardware when all the interrupt sources are cleared.
Endpoint 3 Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when an interrupt has been detected on the endpoint 3.
The interrupt sources are part of UEPSTAX register and can be : TXCMP,
RXOUTB0, RXOUTB1, RXSETUP or STLCRC. A USB interrupt is triggered when
the EP3INTE bit in the UEPIEN register is set.
This bit is cleared by hardware when all the interrupt sources are cleared.
Endpoint 2 Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when an interrupt has been detected on the endpoint 2.
The interrupt sources are part of UEPSTAX register and can be : TXCMP,
RXOUTB0, RXOUTB1, RXSETUP or STLCRC. A USB interrupt is triggered when
the EP2INTE bit in the UEPIEN register is set.
This bit is cleared by hardware when all the interrupt sources are cleared.
Endpoint 1 Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when an interrupt has been detected on the endpoint 1.
The interrupt sources are part of UEPSTAX register and can be : TXCMP,
RXOUTB0, RXOUTB1, RXSETUP or STLCRC. A USB interrupt is triggered when
the EP1INTE bit in the UEPIEN register is set.
This bit is cleared by hardware when all the interrupt sources are cleared.
Endpoint 0 Interrupt
This bit is set by hardware when an interrupt has been detected on the endpoint 0.
The interrupt sources are part of UEPSTAX register and can be : TXCMP,
RXOUTB0, RXOUTB1, RXSETUP or STLCRC. A USB interrupt is triggered when
the EP0INTE bit in the UEPIEN register is set.
This bit is cleared by hardware when all the interrupt sources are cleared.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
124
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 75. USB Endpoint Interrupt Enable Register - UEPIEN (S:C2h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
EP6INTE
EP5INTE
EP4INTE
EP3INTE
EP2INTE
EP1INTE
EP0INTE
Bit Number Bit Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7
-
The value read from these bits is always 0. Do not change this bit.
Endpoint 6 Interrupt Enable
6
EP6INTE
Set this bit to enable the interrupts for this endpoint.
Clear this bit to disable the interrupts for this endpoint.
Endpoint 5 Interrupt Enable
5
4
3
2
1
0
EP5INTE
EP4INTE
EP3INTE
EP2INTE
EP1INTE
EP0INTE
Set this bit to enable the interrupts for this endpoint.
Clear this bit to disable the interrupts for this endpoint.
Endpoint 4 Interrupt Enable
Set this bit to enable the interrupts for this endpoint.
Clear this bit to disable the interrupts for this endpoint.
Endpoint 3 Interrupt Enable
Set this bit to enable the interrupts for this endpoint.
Clear this bit to disable the interrupts for this endpoint.
Endpoint 2 Interrupt Enable
Set this bit to enable the interrupts for this endpoint.
Clear this bit to disable the interrupts for this endpoint.
Endpoint 1 Interrupt Enable
Set this bit to enable the interrupts for this endpoint.
Clear this bit to disable the interrupts for this endpoint.
Endpoint 0 Interrupt Enable
Set this bit to enable the interrupts for this endpoint.
Clear this bit to disable the interrupts for this endpoint.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
125
4202D–SCR–06/05
Serial I/O Port
The serial I/O port in the AT8xC5122/23 is compatible with the serial I/O port in the
80C52.
The I/O port provides both synchronous and asynchronous communication modes. It
operates as an Universal Asynchronous Receiver and Transmitter (UART) in three full-
duplex modes (Modes 1, 2 and 3). Asynchronous transmission and reception can occur
simultaneously and at different baud rates
Serial I/O port includes the following enhancements:
•
•
Framing error detection
Automatic address recognition
Framing Error Detection Framing bit error detection is provided for the three asynchronous modes (Modes 1, 2
and 3). To enable the framing bit error detection feature, set SMOD0 bit in PCON regis-
ter (See Figure 65).
Figure 65. Framing Error Block Diagram
SM0/FE SM1
SM2
REN
TB8
RB8
TI
RI
SCON (98h)
Set FE Bit if Stop Bit is 0 (Framing Error) (SMOD0 = 1)
SM0 to UART Mode Control (SMOD0 = 0)
PCON (87h)
SMOD1 SMOD0
-
POF GF1
GF0
PD
IDL
To UART Framing Error Control
When this feature is enabled, the receiver checks each incoming data frame for a valid
stop bit. An invalid stop bit may result from noise on the serial lines or from simultaneous
transmission by two CPUs. If a valid stop bit is not found, the Framing Error bit (FE) in
SCON register (See Figure 70 on page 130) bit is set.
Software may examine FE bit after each reception to check for data errors. Once set,
only software or a reset can clear FE bit. Subsequently received frames with valid stop
bits cannot clear FE bit. When FE feature is enabled, RI rises on stop bit instead of the
last data bit (See Figure 66 and Figure 67).
Figure 66. UART Timings in Mode 1
RXD
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Start
Bit
Data Byte
Stop
Bit
RI
SMOD0=X
FE
SMOD0=1
126
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 67. UART Timings in Modes 2 and 3
RXD
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
Start
bit
Data byte
Ninth Stop
bit
bit
RI
SMOD0=0
RI
SMOD0=1
FE
SMOD0=1
Automatic Address
Recognition
The automatic address recognition feature is enabled when the multiprocessor commu-
nication feature is enabled (SM2 bit in SCON register is set).
Implemented in hardware, automatic address recognition enhances the multiprocessor
communication feature by allowing the serial port to examine the address of each
incoming command frame. Only when the serial port recognizes its own address, the
receiver sets RI bit in SCON register to generate an interrupt. This ensures that the CPU
is not interrupted by command frames addressed to other devices.
If desired, you may enable the automatic address recognition feature in mode 1. In this
configuration, the stop bit takes the place of the ninth data bit. Bit RI is set only when the
received command frame address matches the device’s address and is terminated by a
valid stop bit.
To support automatic address recognition, a device is identified by a given address and
a broadcast address.
Note:
The multiprocessor communication and automatic address recognition features cannot
be enabled in mode 0 (i.e. setting SM2 bit in SCON register in mode 0 has no effect).
Given Address
Each device has an individual address that is specified in SADDR register; the SADEN
register is a mask byte that contains don’t care bits (defined by zeros) to form the
device’s given address. The don’t care bits provide the flexibility to address one or more
slaves at a time. The following example illustrates how a given address is formed.
To address a device by its individual address, the SADEN mask byte must be 1111
1111b.
For example:
SADDR0101 0110b
SADEN1111 1100b
Given0101 01XXb
The following is an example of how to use given addresses to address different slaves:
Slave A:SADDR1111 0001b
SADEN1111 1010b
Given1111 0X0Xb
Slave B:SADDR1111 0011b
SADEN1111 1001b
Given1111 0XX1b
Slave C:SADDR1111 0011b
SADEN1111 1101b
Given1111 00X1b
127
4202D–SCR–06/05
The SADEN byte is selected so that each slave may be addressed separately.
For slave A, bit 0 (the LSB) is a don’t care bit; for slaves B and C, bit 0 is a 1. To commu-
nicate with slave A only, the master must send an address where bit 0 is clear (e.g.
1111 0000b).
For slave A, bit 1 is a 1; for slaves B and C, bit 1 is a don’t care bit. To communicate with
slaves B and C, but not slave A, the master must send an address with bits 0 and 1 both
set (e.g. 1111 0011b).
To communicate with slaves A, B and C, the master must send an address with bit 0 set,
bit 1 clear, and bit 2 clear (e.g. 1111 0001b).
Broadcast Address
A broadcast address is formed from the logical OR of the SADDR and SADEN registers
with zeros defined as don’t care bits, e.g.:
SADDR0101 0110b
SADEN1111 1100b
Broadcast =SADDR OR SADEN1111 111Xb
The use of don’t care bits provides flexibility in defining the broadcast address, however
in most applications, a broadcast address is FFh. The following is an example of using
broadcast addresses:
Slave A:SADDR1111 0001b
SADEN1111 1010b
Broadcast1111 1X11b,
Slave B:SADDR1111 0011b
SADEN1111 1001b
Broadcast1111 1X11B,
Slave C:SADDR=1111 0010b
SADEN1111 1101b
Broadcast1111 1111b
For slaves A and B, bit 2 is a don’t care bit; for slave C, bit 2 is set. To communicate with
all of the slaves, the master must send an address FFh. To communicate with slaves A
and B, but not slave C, the master can send and address FBh.
Reset Addresses
Timer 1
On reset, the SADDR and SADEN registers are initialized to 00h, i.e. the given and
broadcast addresses are XXXX XXXXb(all don’t care bits). This ensures that the serial
port will reply to any address, and so, that it is backwards compatible with the 80C51
microcontrollers that does not support automatic address recognition.
When using the Timer 1, the Baud Rate is derived from the overflow of the timer. As
shown in Figure 68 the Timer 1 is used in its 8-bit auto-reload mode). SMOD1 bit in
PCON register allows doubling of the generated baud rate.
128
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 68. Timer 1 Baud Rate Generator Block Diagram
CK_
T1
/ 6
0
1
Overflow
TL1
/ 2
0
(8 bits)
To serial Port
1
T1
C/T1#
TMOD.6
SMOD1
T1
INT1#
PCON.7
CLOCK
TH1
GATE1
(8 bits)
TR1
TMOD.7
TCON.6
Internal Baud Rate Generator When using the Internal Baud Rate Generator, the Baud Rate is derived from the over-
flow of the timer. As shown in Figure 69 the Internal Baud Rate Generator is an 8-bit
auto-reload timer feed by the peripheral clock or by the peripheral clock divided by 6
depending on the SPD bit in BDRCON register (see Table 82 on page 136). The Internal
Baud Rate Generator is enabled by setting BRR bit in BDRCON register. SMOD1 bit in
PCON register allows doubling of the generated baud rate.
Figure 69. Internal Baud Rate Generator Block Diagram
CK_
/ 6
0
1
Overflow
BRG
SI
/ 2
0
1
(8 bits)
To serial Port
SPD
BRR
BDRCON.1
BDRCON.4
SMOD1
IBRG
PCON.7
CLOCK
BRL
(8 bits)
Synchronous Mode (Mode 0)
Mode 0 is a half-duplex, synchronous mode, which is commonly used to expand the I/0
capabilities of a device with shift registers. The transmit data (TXD) pin outputs a set of
eight clock pulses while the receive data (RXD) pin transmits or receives a byte of data.
The 8-bit data are transmitted and received least-significant bit (LSB) first. Shifts occur
at a fixed Baud Rate (see Section “Baud Rate Selection (Mode 0)”). Figure 70 shows
the serial port block diagram in Mode 0.
129
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 70. Serial I/O Port Block Diagram (Mode 0)
SCON.6
SM1
SCON.7
SM0
SBUF Tx SR
SBUF Rx SR
RXD
Mode Decoder
M3 M2 M1 M0
Mode
Controller
CK_
T1
Baud Rate
Controller
TI
RI
TXD
SCON.1
SCON.0
IBRG
CLOCK
Transmission (Mode 0)
To start a transmission mode 0, write to SCON register clearing bits SM0, SM1.
As shown in Figure 71, writing the byte to transmit to SBUF register starts the transmis-
sion. Hardware shifts the LSB (D0) onto the RXD pin during the first clock cycle
composed of a high level then low level signal on TXD. During the eighth clock cycle the
MSB (D7) is on the RXD pin. Then, hardware drives the RXD pin high and asserts TI to
indicate the end of the transmission.
Figure 71. Transmission Waveforms (Mode 0)
TXD
Write to SBUF
RXD
TI
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Reception (Mode 0)
To start a reception in mode 0, write to SCON register clearing SM0, SM1 and RI bits
and setting the REN bit.
As shown in Figure 72, Clock is pulsed and the LSB (D0) is sampled on the RXD pin.
The D0 bit is then shifted into the shift register. After eight sampling, the MSB (D7) is
shifted into the shift register, and hardware asserts RI bit to indicate a completed recep-
tion. Software can then read the received byte from SBUF register.
Figure 72. Reception Waveforms (Mode 0)
TXD
Set REN, Clear RI
D0 D1 D2
Write to SCON
RXD
RI
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
130
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Baud Rate Selection (Mode 0) In mode 0, baud rate can be either fixed or variable.
As shown in Figure 73, the selection is done using M0SRC bit in BDRCON register.
Figure 74 gives the baud rate calculation formulas for each baud rate source.
Figure 73. Baud Rate Source Selection (Mode 0)
CK_
/ 6
SI
0
To Serial Port
1
IBRG
CLOCK
M0SRC
BDRCON.0
Figure 74. Baud Rate Formulas (Mode 0)
2SMOD1 ⋅ FCK_SI
Baud_Rate =
BRL = 256 -
6(1-SPD) ⋅ 32 ⋅ (256 -BRL)
FCK_SI
2SMOD1 ⋅ FCK_SI
Baud_Rate =
6
6(1-SPD) ⋅ 32 ⋅ Baud_Rate
a. Fixed Formula
b. Variable Formula
Asynchronous Modes
(Modes 1, 2 and 3)
The Serial Port has one 8-bit and two 9-bit asynchronous modes of operation. Figure 75
shows the Serial Port block diagram in such asynchronous modes.
Figure 75. Serial I/O Port Block Diagram (Modes 1, 2 and 3)
SCON.3
TB8
SSCOMN1.6
SSCOMN0.7
SBUF Tx SR
TXD
RXD
Mode Decoder
M3 M2 M1 M0
T1
Rx SR
CLOCK
IBRG
Mode & Clock
Controller
CLOCK
SBUF Rx
RB8
CK_
SI
SCON.2
SM2
TI
RI
SCON.4
SCON.1
SCON.0
Mode 1
Mode 1 is a full-duplex, asynchronous mode. The data frame (see Figure 76) consists of
10 bits: one start, eight data bits and one stop bit. Serial data is transmitted on the TXD
pin and received on the RXD pin. When a data is received, the stop bit is read in the
RB8 bit in SCON register.
131
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 76. Data Frame Format (Mode 1)
Mode 1
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Start bit
8-bit data
Stop bit
Modes 2 and 3
Modes 2 and 3 are full-duplex, asynchronous modes. The data frame (see Figure 77)
consists of 11 bits: one start bit, eight data bits (transmitted and received LSB first), one
programmable ninth data bit and one stop bit. Serial data is transmitted on the TXD pin
and received on the RXD pin. On receive, the ninth bit is read from RB8 bit in SCON
register. On transmit, the ninth data bit is written to TB8 bit in SCON register. Alterna-
tively, you can use the ninth bit as a command/data flag.
Figure 77. Data Frame Format (Modes 2 and 3)
Modes 2 and 3
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
D8
Start bit
9-bit data
Stop bit
Transmission
To initiate a transmission, write to SCON register, setting SM0 and SM1 bits according
to Figure 70 on page 130, and setting the ninth bit by writing to TB8 bit. Then, writing the
byte to be transmitted to SBUF register starts the transmission.
(Modes 1, 2 and 3)
Reception
To prepare for a reception, write to SCON register, setting SM0 and SM1 bits according
to Figure 70 on page 130, and setting REN bit. The actual reception is then initiated by a
detected high-to-low transition on the RXD pin.
(Modes 1, 2 and 3)
Framing Error Detection
(Modes 1, 2 and 3)
Framing error detection is provided for the three asynchronous modes. To enable the
framing bit error detection feature, set SMOD0 bit in PCON register as shown in
Figure 78.
When this feature is enabled, the receiver checks each incoming data frame for a valid
stop bit. An invalid stop bit may result from noise on the serial lines or from simultaneous
transmission by two devices. If a valid stop bit is not found, the software sets FE bit in
SCON register.
Software may examine FE bit after each reception to check for data errors. Once set,
only software or a chip reset clear FE bit. Subsequently received frames with valid stop
bits cannot clear FE bit. When the framing error detection feature is enabled, RI rises on
stop bit instead of the last data bit as detailed in Figure 76 and Figure 77.
Figure 78. Framing Error Block Diagram
Framing Error
FE
1
0
Controller
SM0/FE
SCON.7
SM0
SMOD0
PCON.6
132
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Baud Rate Selection
(Modes 1 and 3)
In modes 1 and 3, the Baud Rate is derived either from the Timer 1 or the Internal Baud
Rate Generator and allows different baud rate in reception and transmission.
As shown in Figure 79 the selection is done using RBCK and TBCK bits in BDRCON
register.
Figure 80 gives the baud rate calculation formulas for each baud rate source while
Table 76 details Internal Baud Rate Generator configuration for different peripheral
clock frequencies and giving baud rates closer to the standard baud rates.
Figure 79. Baud Rate Source Selection (Modes 1 and 3)
T1
T1
CLOCK
CLOCK
0
1
0
1
To serial
To serial
/ 16
/ 16
reception Port
transmission Port
IBRG
IBRG
CLOCK
CLOCK
RBCK
TBCK
BDRCON.2
BDRCON.3
Figure 80. Baud Rate Formulas (Modes 1 and 3)
2SMOD1 ⋅ FCK_SI
2SMOD1 ⋅ FCK_T1
Baud_Rate =
Baud_Rate =
TH1 = 256 -
6(1-SPD) ⋅ 32 ⋅ (256 -BRL)
6 ⋅ 32 ⋅ (256 -TH1)
2SMOD1 ⋅ FCK_SI
BRL = 256 -
2SMOD1 ⋅ FCK_T1
192 ⋅ Baud_Rate
6(1-SPD) ⋅ 32 ⋅ Baud_Rate
a. IBRG Formula
b. T1 Formula
133
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 76. Internal Baud Rate Generator Value
FCK_IDLE= 4 MHz
FCK_IDLE= 8 MHz
FCK_IDLE= 9.6 MHz
Baud Rate
115200
57600
38400
19200
9600
SPD
SMOD1
BRL
254
252
249
243
230
204
Error%
8.51
SPD
SMOD1
BRL
252
247
243
230
204
152
Error%
8.51
SPD
SMOD1
BRL
251
246
240
225
194
131
Error%
4.17
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
8.51
3.55
4.17
6.99
0.16
2.34
0.16
0.16
0.81
0.16
0.16
0.81
4800
0.16
0.16
0.00
FCK_IDLE= 12 MHz
FCK_IDLE= 16 MHz
FCK_IDLE= 24 MHz
Baud Rate
115200
57600
38400
19200
9600
SPD
SMOD1
BRL
249
243
236
217
178
100
Error%
6.99
SPD
SMOD1
BRL
247
239
230
204
152
48
Error%
3.55
SPD
SMOD1
BRL
243
230
217
178
100
N/A
Error%
0.16
0.16
0.16
0.16
0.16
N/A
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0.16
2.12
2.34
0.16
0.16
0.16
0.16
0.16
4800
0.16
0.16
Baud Rate Selection (Mode 2) In mode 2, the baud rate can only be programmed to two fixed values: 1/16 or 1/32 of
the peripheral clock frequency.
As shown in Figure 81 the selection is done using SMOD1 bit in PCON register.
Figure 82 gives the baud rate calculation formula depending on the selection.
Figure 81. Baud Rate Generator Selection (Mode 2)
CK_
/ 2
0
1
SI
³ 16
To Serial Port
SMOD1
PCON.7
Figure 82. Baud Rate Formula (Mode 2)
2SMOD1 ⋅ FCK_SI
Baud_Rate =
32
For mode 0 for UART, thanks to the bit M0SRC located in BDRCON register (Table 82)
134
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Registers
Table 77. Serial Control Register - SCON (98h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FE/SM0
SM1
SM2
REN
TB8
RB8
TI
RI
Bit
Bit
Number Mnemonic Description
Framing Error bit (SMOD0=1)
Clear to reset the error state, not cleared by a valid stop bit.
Set by hardware when an invalid stop bit is detected.
FE
SMOD0 in PCON register must be set to enable access to the FE bit
7
Serial port Mode bit 0 (SMOD0=1)
Refer to SM1 for serial port mode selection.
SM0
SMOD0 in PCON register must be cleared to enable access to the SM0 bit
Serial port Mode bit 1
SM0
SM1
Mode
DescriptionBaud Rate
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
2
Shift Register FCk_IDLE/6
6
5
SM1
SM2
8-bit UARTVariable
9-bit UARTFCK_IDLE /32 or /16
9-bit UARTVariable
1
1
3
Serial port Mode 2 bit/Multiprocessor Communication Enable bit
Clear to disable multiprocessor communication feature.
Set to enable multiprocessor communication feature in mode 2 and 3, and
eventually mode 1.
This bit should be cleared in mode 0.
Reception Enable bit
4
3
REN
TB8
Clear to disable serial reception.
Set to enable serial reception.
Transmitter Bit 8/Ninth bit to transmit in modes 2 and 3
Clear to transmit a logic 0 in the 9th bit.
Set to transmit a logic 1 in the 9th bit.
Receiver Bit 8/Ninth bit received in modes 2 and 3
Cleared by hardware if 9th bit received is a logic 0.
Set by hardware if 9th bit received is a logic 1.
2
1
0
RB8
TI
In mode 1, if SM2 = 0, RB8 is the received stop bit. In mode 0 RB8 is not used.
Transmit Interrupt flag
Clear to acknowledge interrupt.
Set by hardware at the end of the 8th bit time in mode 0 or at the beginning of the
stop bit in the other
modes.
Receive Interrupt flag
Clear to acknowledge interrupt.
RI
Set by hardware at the end of the 8th bit time in mode 0, see Figure 66 and Figure
67 in the other modes.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b (Bit addressable)
135
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 78. Slave Address Mask Register for UART - SADEN (B9h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
1
1
0
0
0
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
Table 79. Slave Address Register for UART - SADDR (A9h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
2
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
Table 80. Serial Buffer Register for UART - SBUF (99h)
7
6
5
4
3
Reset Value = XXXX XXXXb
Table 81. Baud Rate Reload Register for the internal baud rate generator,
UART - BRL (9Ah)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
Table 82. Baud Rate Control Register - BDRCON - (9Bh)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
BRR
TBCK
RBCK
SPD
M0SRC
Bit
Bit
Number Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7 - 5
4
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
Baud Rate Run Control bit
BRR
Cleared to stop the internal Baud Rate Generator.
Set to start the internal Baud Rate Generator.
Transmission Baud rate Generator Selection bit for UART
Cleared to select Timer 1 for the Baud Rate Generator.
Set to select internal Baud Rate Generator.
3
2
1
0
TBCK
RBCK
SPD
Reception Baud Rate Generator Selection bit for UART
Cleared to select Timer 1 for the Baud Rate Generator.
Set to select internal Baud Rate Generator.
Baud Rate Speed Control bit for UART
Cleared to select the SLOW Baud Rate Generator.
Set to select the FAST Baud Rate Generator.
Baud Rate Source select bit in Mode 0 for UART
Cleared to select FCK_SI /6 as the Baud Rate Generator.
Set to select the internal Baud Rate Generator for UART in mode 0.
M0SRC
Reset Value = XXX0 0000b (Not bit addressable)
136
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Serial Port Interface
(SPI)
Only for AT8xC5122.
The Serial Peripheral Interface module (SPI) which allows full-duplex, synchronous,
serial communication between the MCU and peripheral devices, including other MCUs.
Features
Features of the SPI module include the following:
•
•
•
•
•
•
Full-duplex, three-wire synchronous transfers
Master or Slave operation
Eight programmable Master clock rates
Serial clock with programmable polarity and phase
Master Mode fault error flag with MCU interrupt capability
Write collision flag protection
Signal Description
Figure 83 shows a typical SPI bus configuration using one Master controller and many
Slave peripherals. The bus is made of three wires connecting all the devices:
Figure 83. Typical SPI Bus
Slave 1
MISO
MOSI
SCK
SS
VDD
Master
0
1
2
3
Slave 4
Slave 3
Slave 2
The Master device selects the individual Slave devices by using four pins of a parallel
port to control the four SS pins of the Slave devices.
Master Output Slave Input
(MOSI)
This 1-bit signal is directly connected between the Master Device and a Slave Device.
The MOSI line is used to transfer data in series from the Master to the Slave. Therefore,
it is an output signal from the Master, and an input signal to a Slave. A byte (8-bit word)
is transmitted most significant bit (MSB) first, least significant bit (LSB) last.
Master Input Slave Output
(MISO)
This 1-bit signal is directly connected between the Slave Device and a Master Device.
The MISO line is used to transfer data in series from the Slave to the Master. Therefore,
it is an output signal from the Slave, and an input signal to the Master. A byte (8-bit
word) is transmitted most significant bit (MSB) first, least significant bit (LSB) last.
SPI Serial Clock (SCK)
This signal is used to synchronize the data movement both in and out the devices
through their MOSI and MISO lines. It is driven by the Master for eight clock cycles
which allows to exchange one byte on the serial lines.
137
4202D–SCR–06/05
Slave Select (SS)
Each Slave peripheral is selected by one Slave Select pin (SS). This signal must stay
low for any message for a Slave. Only one Master (SS high level) can drive the network.
The Master may select each Slave device by software through port pins (Figure 83). To
prevent bus conflicts on the MISO line, only one slave should be selected at a time by
the Master for a transmission.
In a Master configuration, the SS line can be used in conjunction with the MODF flag in
the SPI Status register (SPSTA) to prevent multiple masters from driving MOSI and
SCK (see Section “Error Conditions”, page 142).
A high level on the SS pin puts the MISO line of a Slave SPI in a high-impedance state.
The SS pin could be used as a general-purpose if the following conditions are met:
•
The device is configured as a Master and the SSDIS control bit in SPCON is set.
This kind of configuration can be found when only one Master is driving the network
and there is no way that the SS pin will be pulled low. Therefore, the MODF flag in
the SPSTA will never be set (1)
.
•
The Device is configured as a Slave with CPHA and SSDIS control bits set (2). This
kind of configuration can happen when the system comprises one Master and one
Slave only. Therefore, the device should always be selected and there is no reason
that the Master uses the SS pin to select the communicating Slave device.
Baud Rate
In Master mode, the baud rate can be selected from a baud rate generator which is con-
troled by three bits in the SPCON register: SPR2, SPR1 and SPR0. The Master clock is
chosen from one of six clock rates resulting from the division of the internal clock by 4, 8,
16, 32, 64 or 128.
Table 83 gives the different clock rates selected by SPR2:SPR1:SPR0
Table 83. SPI Master Baud Rate Selection
SPR2:SPR1:SPR0
Clock Rate
Baud Rate Divisor (BD)
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
Reserved
N/A
4
F
CK_SPI /4
CK_SPI / 8
CK_SPI /16
F
8
F
16
32
64
128
N/A
F
F
CK_SPI /32
CK_SPI /64
F
CK_SPI /128
Reserved
1.
2.
Clearing SSDIS control bit does not clear MODF.
Special care should be taken not to set SSDIS control bit when CPHA = ’0’ because in
this mode, the SS is used to start the transmission.
138
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Functional Description
Figure 84 shows a detailed structure of the SPI module.
Figure 84. SPI Module Block Diagram
Internal Bus
SPDAT
Shift Register
IntClk
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
/4
/8
Clock
Divider
Receive Data Register
/16
/32
/64
/128
Pin
MOSI
Control
MISO
Logic
Clock
Logic
M
S
SCK
SS
Clock
Select
SPR2 SPEN SSDIS MSTR CPOL CPHA SPR1 SPR0
SPCON
SPI
Control
8-bit bus
1-bit signal
SPI Interrupt Request
SPSTA
-
-
-
-
-
SPIF WCOL
MODF
Operating Modes
The Serial Peripheral Interface can be configured as one of the two modes: Master
mode or Salve mode. The configuration and initialization of the SPI module is made
through one register:
•
The Serial Peripheral Control register (SPCON)
Once the SPI is configured, the data exchange is made using:
•
•
•
SPCON
The Serial Peripheral Status register (SPSTA)
The Serial Peripheral Data register (SPDAT)
During an SPI transmission, data is simultaneously transmitted (shifted out serially) and
received (shifted in serially). A serial clock line (SCK) synchronizes shifting and sam-
pling on the two serial data lines (MOSI and MISO). A Slave Select line (SS) allows
individual selection of a Slave SPI device; Slave devices that are not selected do not
interfere with SPI bus activities.
When the Master device transmits data to the Slave device via the MOSI line, the Slave
device responds by sending data to the Master device via the MISO line. This implies
full-duplex transmission with both data out and data in synchronized with the same clock
(Figure 85).
139
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 85. Full-duplex Master-Slave Interconnection
MISO
MOSI
MISO
MOSI
8-bit Shift Register
8-bit Shift Register
SPI
SCK
SS
SCK
Clock Generator
SS
VDD
Master MCU
Slave MCU
VSS
Master Mode
The SPI operates in Master mode when the Master bit, MSTR (3), in the SPCON register
is set. Only one Master SPI device can initiate transmissions. Software begins the trans-
mission from a Master SPI module by writing to the Serial Peripheral Data Register
(SPDAT). If the shift register is empty, the byte is immediately transferred to the shift
register. The byte begins shifting out on MOSI pin under the control of the serial clock,
SCK. Simultaneously, another byte shifts in from the Slave on the Master’s MISO pin.
The transmission ends when the Serial Peripheral transfer data flag, SPIF, in SPSTA
becomes set. At the same time that SPIF becomes set, the received byte from the Slave
is transferred to the receive data register in SPDAT. Software clears SPIF by reading
the Serial Peripheral Status register (SPSTA) with the SPIF bit set, and then reading the
SPDAT.
When the pin SS is pulled down during a transmission, the data is interrupted and when
the transmission is established again, the data present in the SPDAT is resent.
Slave Mode
The SPI operates in Slave mode when the Master bit, MSTR(4), in the SPCON register is
cleared. Before a data transmission occurs, the Slave Select pin, SS, of the Slave
device must be set to ’0’. SS must remain low until the transmission is complete.
In a Slave SPI module, data enters the shift register under the control of the SCK from
the Master SPI module. After a byte enters the shift register, it is immediately transferred
to the receive data register in SPDAT, and the SPIF bit is set. To prevent an overflow
condition, Slave software must then read the SPDAT before another byte enters the
shift register (5). A Slave SPI must complete the write to the SPDAT (shift register) at
least one bus cycle before the Master SPI starts a transmission. If the write to the data
register is late, the SPI transmits the data already in the shift register from the previous
transmission.
Transmission Formats
Software can select any of four combinations of serial clock (SCK) phase and polarity
using two bits in the SPCON: the Clock Polarity (CPOL (6)) and the Clock Phase
(CPHA(4)). CPOL defines the default SCK line level in idle state. It has no significant
effect on the transmission format. CPHA defines the edges on which the input data are
sampled and the edges on which the output data are shifted (Figure 86 and Figure 87).
The clock phase and polarity should be identical for the Master SPI device and the com-
municating Slave device.
3.
The SPI module should be configured as a Master before it is enabled (SPEN set). Also
the Master SPI should be configured before the Slave SPI.
4.
5.
The SPI module should be configured as a Slave before it is enabled (SPEN set).
The maximum frequency of the SCK for an SPI configured as a Slave is the bus clock
speed.
6.
Before writing to the CPOL and CPHA bits, the SPI should be disabled (SPEN = ’0’).
140
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 86. Data Transmission Format (CPHA = 0)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
SCK Cycle Number
SPEN (internal)
SCK (CPOL = 0)
SCK (CPOL = 1)
MOSI (from Master)
MSB
bit6
bit6
bit5
bit5
bit4
bit4
bit3
bit3
bit2
bit2
bit1
bit1
LSB
LSB
MISO (from Slave)
MSB
SS (to Slave)
Capture Point
Figure 87. Data Transmission Format (CPHA = 1)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
SCK Cycle Number
SPEN (internal)
SCK (CPOL = 0)
SCK (CPOL = 1)
MSB
MSB
bit6
bit6
bit5
bit5
bit4
bit4
bit3
bit3
bit2
bit2
bit1
bit1
LSB
LSB
MOSI (from Master)
MISO (from Slave)
SS (to Slave)
Capture point
As shown in Figure 86, the first SCK edge is the MSB capture strobe. Therefore the
Slave must begin driving its data before the first SCK edge, and a falling edge on the SS
pin is used to start the transmission. The SS pin must be toggled high and then low
between each byte transmitted (Figure 88).
Figure 88. CPHA/SS Timing
Byte 3
MISO/MOSI
Master SS
Byte 1
Byte 2
Slave SS
(CPHA = 0)
Slave SS
(CPHA = 1)
Figure 87 shows an SPI transmission in which CPHA is “1”. In this case, the Master
begins driving its MOSI pin on the first SCK edge. Therefore, the Slave uses the first
SCK edge as a start transmission signal. The SS pin can remain low between transmis-
141
4202D–SCR–06/05
sions (Figure 88). This format may be preferable in systems having only one Master and
only one Slave driving the MISO data line.
Error Conditions
The following flags in the SPSTA signal SPI error conditions.
Mode Fault (MODF)
MODF error bit in Master mode SPI indicates that the level on the Slave Select (SS) pin
is inconsistent with the actual mode of the device. MODF is set to warn that there may
have a multi-master conflict for system control. In this case, the SPI system is affected in
the following ways:
•
•
•
An SPI receiver/error CPU interrupt request is generated.
The SPEN bit in SPCON is cleared. This disable the SPI.
The MSTR bit in SPCON is cleared.
When SS Disable (SSDIS) bit in the SPCON register is cleared, the MODF flag is set
when the SS signal becomes ’0’.
However, as stated before, for a system with one Master, if the SS pin of the Master
device is pulled low, there is no way that another Master is attempting to drive the net-
work. In this case, to prevent the MODF flag from being set, software can set the SSDIS
bit in the SPCON register and therefore making the SS pin as a general-purpose I/O pin.
Clearing the MODF bit is accomplished by a read of SPSTA register with MODF bit set,
followed by a write to the SPCON register. SPEN Control bit may be restored to its orig-
inal set state after the MODF bit has been cleared.
Write Collision (WCOL)
Overrun Condition
A Write Collision (WCOL) flag in the SPSTA is set when a write to the SPDAT register is
done during a transmit sequence.
WCOL does not cause an interruption, and the transfer continues uninterrupted.
Clearing the WCOL bit is done through a software sequence of an access to SPSTA
and an access to SPDAT.
An overrun condition occurs when the Master device tries to send several data bytes
and the Slave device has not cleared the SPIF bit issuing from the previous data byte
transmitted. In this case, the receiver buffer contains the byte sent after the SPIF bit was
last cleared. A read of the SPDAT returns this byte. All others bytes are lost.
This condition is not detected by the SPI peripheral.
SS Error Flag ( SSERR )
A Synchronous Serial Slave Error occurs when SS goes high before the end of a
received data in slave mode. SSERR does not cause in interruption, this bit is cleared
by writing 0 to SPEN bit ( reset of the SPI state machine ).
Interrupts
Two SPI status flags can generate a CPU interrupt requests:
Table 84. SPI Interrupts
Flag
Request
SPIF (SP data transfer)
MODF (Mode Fault)
SPI Transmitter Interrupt request
SPI Receiver/Error Interrupt Request (if SSDIS = ’0’)
Serial Peripheral data transfer flag, SPIF: This bit is set by hardware when a transfer
has been completed. SPIF bit generates transmitter CPU interrupt requests.
142
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Mode Fault flag, MODF: This bit becomes set to indicate that the level on the SS is
inconsistent with the mode of the SPI. MODF with SSDIS reset, generates receiver/error
CPU interrupt requests.
Figure 89 gives a logical view of the above statements.
Figure 89. SPI Interrupt Requests Generation
SPIF
SPI Transmitter
SPI
CPU Interrupt Request
CPU Interrupt Request
MODF
SSDIS
SPI Receiver/error
CPU Interrupt Request
Registers
There are three registers in the module that provide control, status and data storage
functions. These registers are describes in the following paragraphs.
Serial Peripheral Control
Register (SPCON)
The Serial Peripheral Control Register does the following:
•
•
•
•
•
Selects one of the Master clock rates
Configures the SPI module as Master or Slave
Selects serial clock polarity and phase
Enables the SPI module
Frees the SS pin for a general-purpose
143
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 85. Serial Peripheral Control Register - SPCON (C3h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SPR2
SPEN
SSDIS
MSTR
CPOL
CPHA
SPR1
SPR0
Bit
Bit
R/W
Number
Mnemonic
Mode Description
Serial Peripheral Rate 2
Bit with SPR1 and SPR0 define the clock rate
7
6
SPR2
SPEN
RW
Serial Peripheral Enable
RW Clear to disable the SPI interface (internal reset of the SPI)
Set to enable the SPI interface
SS Disable
Clear to enable SS in both Master and Slave modes
Set to disable SS in both Master and Slave modes. In Slave mode, this
bit has no effect if CPHA = ’0’
5
SSDIS
RW
Serial Peripheral Master
RW Clear to configure the SPI as a Slave
4
3
MSTR
CPOL
Set to configure the SPI as a Master
Clock Polarity
RW Clear to have the SCK set to ’0’ in idle state
Set to have the SCK set to ’1’ in idle low
Clock Phase
Clear to have the data sampled when the SPSCK leaves the idle state
RW (see CPOL)
2
CPHA
Set to have the data sampled when the SPSCK returns to idle state
(see CPOL)
Serial Peripheral Rate (SPR2:SPR1:SPR0)
000: Reserved
1
0
SPR1
SPR0
RW
RW
001: FCK_SPI /4
010: FCK_SPI/8
011: FCK_SPI/16
100: FCK_SPI/32
101: FCK_SPI/64
110: FCK_SPI/128
111: Reserved
Reset Value = 00010100b
144
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Serial Peripheral Status Register The Serial Peripheral Status Register contains flags to signal the following
(SPSTA)
conditions:
•
•
•
Data transfer complete
Write collision
Inconsistent logic level on SS pin (mode fault error)
Table 86. Serial Peripheral Status and Control Register - SPSTA (C4h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SPIF
WCOL
SSERR
MODF
-
-
-
-
Bit
Bit
R/W
Number
Mnemonic Mode Description
Serial Peripheral data transfer flag
Clear by hardware to indicate data transfer is in progress or has been
approved by a clearing sequence.
7
SPIF
R
Set by hardware to indicate that the data transfer has been completed.
Write Collision flag
Cleared by hardware to indicate that no collision has occurred or has
6
5
WCOL
R
R
been approved by a clearing sequence.
Set by hardware to indicate that a collision has been detected.
Synchronous Serial Slave Error flag
Set by hardware when SS is modified before the end of a received data.
SSERR
Cleared by disabling the SPI (clearing SPEN bit in SPCON).
Mode Fault
Cleared by hardware to indicate that the SS pin is at appropriate logic
4
MODF
-
R
level, or has been approved by a clearing sequence.
Set by hardware to indicate that the SS pin is at inappropriate logic level
Reserved
3 - 0
RW
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
Reset Value = 00X0XXXXb
145
4202D–SCR–06/05
Serial Peripheral DATa Register The Serial Peripheral Data Register (Table 87) is a read/write buffer for the receive data
(SPDAT)
register. A write to SPDAT places data directly into the shift register. No transmit buffer
is available in this model.
A read of the SPDAT returns the value located in the receive buffer and not the content
of the shift register.
Table 87. Serial Peripheral Data Register - SPDAT (C5h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
R7
R6
R5
R4
R3
R2
R1
R0
Bit
Bit Number Mnemonic Description
Receive data bits
SPCON, SPSTA and SPDAT registers may be read and written at any time while
there is no on-going exchange. However, special care should be taken when
writing to them while a transmission is on-going:
Do not change SPR2, SPR1 and SPR0
Do not change CPHA and CPOL
7-0
R7:0
Do not change MSTR
Clearing SPEN would immediately disable the peripheral
Writing to the SPDAT will cause an overflow
Reset Value = XXXX XXXXb
146
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Timers/Counters
The AT8xC5122D implements two general-purpose, 16-bit Timers/Counters. Although
they are identified as Timer 0, Timer 1, you can independently configure each to operate
in a variety of modes as a Timer or as an event Counter. When operating as a Timer, a
Timer/Counter runs for a programmed length of time, then issues an interrupt request.
When operating as a Counter, a Timer/Counter counts negative transitions on an exter-
nal pin. After a preset number of counts, the Counter issues an interrupt request.
The Timer registers and associated control registers are implemented as addressable
Special Function Registers (SFRs). Two of the SFRs provide programmable control of
the Timers as follows:
•
Timer/Counter mode control register (TMOD) and Timer/Counter control register
(TCON) control respectively Timer 0 and Timer 1.
The various operating modes of each Timer/Counter are described below.
Timer/Counter
Operations
For example, a basic operation is Timer registers THx and TLx (x= 0, 1) connected in
cascade to form a 16-bit Timer. Setting the run control bit (TRx) in the TCON register
(see Table 88 on page 152) turns the Timer on by allowing the selected input to incre-
ment TLx. When TLx overflows, it increments THx and when THx overflows it sets the
Timer overflow flag (TFx) in the TCON register. Setting the TRx does not clear the THx
and TLx Timer registers. Timer registers can be accessed to obtain the current count or
to enter preset values. They can be read at any time but the TRx bit must be cleared to
preset their values, otherwise the behavior of the Timer/Counter is unpredictable.
The C/Tx# control bit selects Timer operation or Counter operation by selecting the
divided-down system clock or the external pin Tx as the source for the counted signal.
The TRx bit must be cleared when changing the operating mode, otherwise the behavior
of the Timer/Counter is unpredictable.
For Timer operation (C/Tx#= 0), the Timer register counts the divided-down system
clock. The Timer register is incremented once every peripheral cycle.
Exceptions are the Timer 2 Baud Rate and Clock-Out modes in which the Timer register
is incremented by the system clock divided by two.
For Counter operation (C/Tx#= 1), the Timer register counts the negative transitions on
the Tx external input pin. The external input is sampled during every S5P2 state. The
Programmer’s Guide describes the notation for the states in a peripheral cycle. When
the sample is high in one cycle and low in the next one, the Counter is incremented. The
new count value appears in the register during the next S3P1 state after the transition
has been detected. Since it takes 12 states (24 oscillator periods) to recognize a nega-
tive transition, the maximum count rate is 1/24 of the oscillator frequency. There are no
restrictions on the duty cycle of the external input signal, but to ensure that a given level
is sampled at least once before it changes, it should be held for at least one full periph-
eral cycle.
Timer 0
Timer 0 functions as either a Timer or an event Counter in four operating modes.
Figure 90 through Figure 96 show the logic configuration of each mode.
Timer 0 is controlled by the four lower bits of the TMOD register (see Table 89 on page
153) and bits 0, 1, 4 and 5 of the TCON register (see Table 88 on page 152). The TMOD
register selects the method of Timer gating (GATE0), Timer or Counter operation
(T/C0#) and the operating mode (M10 and M00). The TCON register provides Timer 0
control functions: overflow flag (TF0), run control bit (TR0), interrupt flag (IE0) and inter-
rupt type control bit (IT0).
147
4202D–SCR–06/05
For normal Timer operation (GATE0= 0), setting TR0 allows TL0 to be incremented by
the selected input. Setting GATE0 and TR0 allows external pin INT0# to control Timer
operation.
Timer 0 overflow (count rolls over from all 1s to all 0s) sets the TF0 flag and generates
an interrupt request.
It is important to stop the Timer/Counter before changing modes.
Mode 0 (13-bit Timer)
Mode 0 configures Timer 0 as a 13-bit Timer which is set up as an 8-bit Timer (TH0 reg-
ister) with a modulo-32 prescaler implemented with the lower five bits of the TL0 register
(see Figure 90). The upper three bits of the TL0 register are indeterminate and should
be ignored. Prescaler overflow increments the TH0 register.
Figure 91 gives the overflow period calculation formula.
Figure 90. Timer/Counter x (x= 0 or 1) in Mode 0
FCK_Tx
Timer x
/6
0
1
Overflow
THx
TLx
Interrupt
Request
TFx
(8 bits)
(5 bits)
TCON reg
Tx
C/Tx#
TMOD reg
INTx#
GATEx
TRx
TMOD reg
TCON reg
Figure 91. Mode 0 Overflow Period Formula
6 ⋅ (16384 – (THx, TLx))
TFxPER
=
FCK_Tx
Mode 1 (16-bit Timer)
Mode 1 configures Timer 0 as a 16-bit Timer with the TH0 and TL0 registers connected
in a cascade (see Figure 92). The selected input increments the TL0 register.
Figure 93 gives the overflow period calculation formula when in timer mode.
148
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 92. Timer/Counter x (x = 0 or 1) in Mode 1
FCK_Tx
Timer x
Interrupt
Request
/6
0
1
Overflow
THx
TLx
TFx
(8 bits)
(8 bits)
TCON reg
C/Tx#
TMOD reg
Tx
INTx#
GATEx
TRx
TCON reg
TMOD reg
Figure 93. Mode 1 Overflow Period Formula
6 ⋅ (65536 – (THx, TLx))
TFxPER
=
FCK_Tx
Mode 2 (8-bit Timer with Auto- Mode 2 configures Timer 0 as an 8-bit Timer (TL0 register) that automatically reloads
Reload)
from the TH0 register (see Figure 94). TL0 overflow sets the TF0 flag in the TCON reg-
ister and reloads TL0 with the contents of TH0, which is preset by the software. When
the interrupt request is serviced, the hardware clears TF0. The reload leaves TH0
unchanged. The next reload value may be changed at any time by writing it to the TH0
register.
Figure 95 gives the autoreload period calculation formula when in timer mode.
Figure 94. Timer/Counter x (x = 0 or 1) in Mode 2
FCK_Tx
Tx
Timer x
Interrupt
Request
/6
0
1
Overflow
TLx
TFx
(8 bits)
TCON reg
C/Tx#
TMOD reg
INTx#
THx
(8 bits)
GATEx
TMOD reg
TRx
TCON reg
Figure 95. Mode 2 Autoreload Period Formula
6 ⋅ (256 – THx)
TFxPER
=
FCK_Tx
149
4202D–SCR–06/05
Mode 3 (Two 8-bit Timers)
Mode 3 configures Timer 0 so that registers TL0 and TH0 operate as 8-bit Timers (see
Figure 96). This mode is provided for applications requiring an additional 8-bit Timer or
Counter. TL0 uses the Timer 0 control bits C/T0# and GATE0 in the TMOD register, and
TR0 and TF0 in the TCON register in the normal manner. TH0 is locked into a Timer
function (counting FUART) and takes over use of the Timer 1 interrupt (TF1) and run con-
trol (TR1) bits. Thus, operation of Timer 1 is restricted when Timer 0 is in mode 3.
Figure 97 gives the autoreload period calculation formulas for both TF0 and TF1 flags.
Figure 96. Timer/Counter 0 in Mode 3: Two 8-bit Counters
FCK_T0
T0
Timer 0
Interrupt
Request
/6
0
1
Overflow
TL0
TF0
(8 bits)
TCON.5
C/T0#
TMOD.2
INT0#
GATE0
TMOD.3
TR0
TCON.4
Timer 1
Interrupt
Request
FCK_T0
Overflow
TH0
/6
TF1
(8 bits)
TCON.7
TR1
TCON.6
Figure 97. Mode 3 Overflow Period Formula
6 ⋅ (256 – TH0)
6 ⋅ (256 – TL0)
TF1PER
=
TF0PER
=
FCK_T0
FCK_T0
Timer 1
Timer 1 is identical to Timer 0 except for Mode 3 which is a hold-count mode. The fol-
lowing comments help to understand the differences:
•
Timer 1 functions as either a Timer or an event Counter in three operating modes.
Figure 90 through Figure 94 show the logical configuration for modes 0, 1, and 2.
Mode 3 of Timer 1 is a hold-count mode.
•
Timer 1 is controlled by the four high-order bits of the TMOD register (see Table 89
on page 153) and bits 2, 3, 6 and 7 of the TCON register (see Table 88 on page
152). The TMOD register selects the method of Timer gating (GATE1), Timer or
Counter operation (C/T1#) and the operating mode (M11 and M01). The TCON
register provides Timer 1 control functions: overflow flag (TF1), run control bit (TR1),
interrupt flag (IE1) and the interrupt type control bit (IT1).
•
•
Timer 1 can serve as the Baud Rate Generator for the Serial Port. Mode 2 is best
suited for this purpose.
For normal Timer operation (GATE1 = 0), setting TR1 allows TL1 to be incremented
by the selected input. Setting GATE1 and TR1 allows external pin INT1# to control
Timer operation.
•
Timer 1 overflow (count rolls over from all 1s to all 0s) sets the TF1 flag and
generates an interrupt request.
150
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
•
•
When Timer 0 is in mode 3, it uses Timer 1’s overflow flag (TF1) and run control bit
(TR1). For this situation, use Timer 1 only for applications that do not require an
interrupt (such as a Baud Rate Generator for the Serial Port) and switch Timer 1 in
and out of mode 3 to turn it off and on.
It is important to stop the Timer/Counter before changing modes.
Mode 0 (13-bit Timer)
Mode 1 (16-bit Timer)
Mode 0 configures Timer 1 as a 13-bit Timer, which is set up as an 8-bit Timer (TH1 reg-
ister) with a modulo-32 prescaler implemented with the lower 5 bits of the TL1 register
(see Figure 90). The upper 3 bits of TL1 register are ignored. Prescaler overflow incre-
ments the TH1 register.
Mode 1 configures Timer 1 as a 16-bit Timer with TH1 and TL1 registers connected in
cascade (see Figure 92). The selected input increments the TL1 register.
Mode 2 (8-bit Timer with Auto- Mode 2 configures Timer 1 as an 8-bit Timer (TL1 register) with automatic reload from
Reload)
the TH1 register on overflow (see Figure 94). TL1 overflow sets the TF1 flag in the
TCON register and reloads TL1 with the contents of TH1, which is preset by the soft-
ware. The reload leaves TH1 unchanged.
Mode 3 (Halt)
Placing Timer 1 in mode 3 causes it to halt and hold its count. This can be used to halt
Timer 1 when the TR1 run control bit is not available i.e. when Timer 0 is in mode 3.
151
4202D–SCR–06/05
Registers
Timer/Counter Control Register
Table 88. TCON (S:88h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TF1
TR1
TF0
TR0
IE1
IT1
IE0
IT0
Bit
Bit
Number
Mnemonic Description
Timer 1 Overflow flag
7
6
TF1
TR1
Cleared by the hardware when processor vectors interrupt routine.
Set by the hardware when Timer 1 register overflows.
Timer 1 Run Control bit
Clear to turn off Timer/Counter 1.
Set to turn on Timer/Counter 1.
Timer 0 Overflow flag
Cleared by the hardware when processor vectors interrupt routine or by software
when the interrupt is disabled
Set by the hardware when Timer 0 register overflows.
5
TF0
Timer 0 Run Control bit
4
3
2
1
0
TR0
IE1
IT1
IE0
IT0
Clear to turn off Timer/Counter 0.
Set to turn on Timer/Counter 0.
Interrupt 1 Edge flag
Cleared by the hardware when interrupt is processed if edge-triggered (see IT1).
Set by the hardware when external interrupt is detected on the INT1# pin.
Interrupt 1 Type Control bit
Clear to select low level active (level triggered) for external interrupt 1 (INT1#).
Set to select falling edge active (edge triggered) for external interrupt 1.
Interrupt 0 Edge flag
Cleared by the hardware when interrupt is processed if edge-triggered (see IT0).
Set by the hardware when external interrupt is detected on INT0# pin.
Interrupt 0 Type Control bit
Clear to select low level active (level triggered) for external interrupt 0 (INT0#).
Set to select falling edge active (edge triggered) for external interrupt 0.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
152
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 89. Timer/Counter Mode Control Register - TMOD (S:89h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
GATE1
C/T1#
M11
M01
GATE0
C/T0#
M10
M00
Bit Number
Bit Mnemonic Description
Timer 1 Gating Control bit
7
GATE1
Clear to enable Timer 1 whenever TR1 bit is set.
Set to enable Timer 1 only while INT1# pin is high and TR1 bit is set.
Timer 1 Counter/Timer Select bit
6
5
C/T1#
M11
Clear for Timer operation: Timer 1 counts the divided-down system clock.
Set for Counter operation: Timer 1 counts negative transitions on external pin T1.
Timer 1 Mode Select bits
M11
0
M01
Operating mode
0
1
0
1
Mode 0:8-bit Timer/Counter (TH1) with 5-bit prescaler (TL1).
Mode 1:16-bit Timer/Counter.
0
4
3
M01
1
1
Mode 2:8-bit auto-reload Timer/Counter (TL1). Reloaded from TH1 at overflow.
Mode 3:Timer 1 halted. Retains count.
Timer 0 Gating Control bit
GATE0
Clear to enable Timer 0 whenever TR0 bit is set.
Set to enable Timer/Counter 0 only while INT0# pin is high and TR0 bit is set.
Timer 0 Counter/Timer Select bit
2
1
C/T0#
M10
Clear for Timer operation: Timer 0 counts the divided-down system clock.
Set for Counter operation: Timer 0 counts negative transitions on external pin T0.
Timer 0 Mode Select bit
M10
M00
Operating mode
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Mode 0:8-bit Timer/Counter (TH0) with 5-bit prescaler (TL0).
Mode 1:16-bit Timer/Counter.
0
M00
Mode 2:8-bit auto-reload Timer/Counter (TL0). Reloaded from TH0 at overflow.
Mode 3:TL0 is an 8-bit Timer/Counter.
TH0 is an 8-bit Timer using Timer 1’s TR0 and TF0 bits.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
153
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 90. Timer 0 High Byte Register - TH0 (S:8Ch)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit
Bit Number Mnemonic Description
7:0
High Byte of Timer 0
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
Table 91. Timer 0 Low Byte Register - TL0 (S:8Ah)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit
Bit
Number
Mnemonic Description
7:0
Low Byte of Timer 0
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
Table 92. Timer 1 High Byte Register - TH1 (S:8Dh)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit
Bit Number Mnemonic Description
7:0
High Byte of Timer 1
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
Table 93. Timer 1 Low Byte Register - TL1 (S:8Bh)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Bit
Bit Number Mnemonic Description
7:0
Low Byte of Timer 1
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
154
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Keyboard Interface
Only for AT8xC5122.
Introduction
The AT8xC5122/23 implements a keyboard interface allowing the connection of a 8 x n
matrix keyboard. It is based on 8 inputs with programmable interrupt capability on both
high or low level. These inputs are available as alternate function of P5 and allow to exit
from idle and power-down modes.
Description
The keyboard interfaces with the C51 core through 3 special function registers: KBLS,
the Keyboard Level Selection register (Table 96 on page 158), KBE, The Keyboard
interrupt Enable register (Table 95 on page 157), and KBF, the Keyboard Flag register
(Table ).
Interrupt
The keyboard inputs are considered as 8 independent interrupt sources sharing the
same interrupt vector. An interrupt enable bit ( KBD in IE1) allows global enable or dis-
able of the keyboard interrupt (see Figure 98). As detailed in Figure 99 each keyboard
input has the capability to detect a programmable level according to KBLS.x bit value.
Level detection is then reported in interrupt flags KBF.x that can be masked by software
using KBE.x bits.
This structure allows keyboard arrangement from 1 by n to 8 by n matrix and allows
usage of P5 inputs for other purpose.
The KBF.x flags are set by hardware when an active level is on input P5.x. They are
automatically reset after any read access on KBF. If the content of KBF must be ana-
lyzed, the first read instruction must transfer KBF contend to another location. The KBF
register cannot be written by software.
Figure 98. Keyboard Interface Block Diagram
P5.0
P5.1
P5.2
P5.3
P5.4
P5.5
P5.6
P5.7
Input Circuitry
Input Circuitry
Input Circuitry
Input Circuitry
Input Circuitry
Input Circuitry
Input Circuitry
Input Circuitry
KBDIT
Keyboard Interface
Interrupt Request
EKB
IEN1.0
Figure 99. Keyboard Input Circuitry
0
P5.x
KBF.x
1
KBE.x
KBLS.x
155
4202D–SCR–06/05
Power Reduction Mode
P5 inputs allow exit from idle and power-down modes as detailed in Section "Power-
Down Mode".
Registers
Table 94. Keyboard Flag Register - KBF (9Eh)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
KBF7
KBF6
KBF5
KBF4
KBF3
KBF2
KBF1
KBF0
Bit
Bit
Number Mnemonic Description
Keyboard line 7 flag
Set by hardware when the Port line 7 detects a programmed level. It generates a
Keyboard interrupt request if the KBE.7 bit in KBE register is set.
Cleared by hardware after the read of the KBF register.
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
KBF7
KBF6
KBF5
KBF4
KBF3
KBF2
KBF1
KBF0
Keyboard line 6 flag
Set by hardware when the Port line 6 detects a programmed level. It generates a
Keyboard interrupt request if the KBE.6 bit in KBE register is set.
Cleared by hardware after the read of the KBF register.
Keyboard line 5 flag
Set by hardware when the Port line 5 detects a programmed level. It generates a
Keyboard interrupt request if the KBE.5 bit in KBE register is set.
Cleared by hardware after the read of the KBF register.
Keyboard line 4 flag
Set by hardware when the Port line 4 detects a programmed level. It generates a
Keyboard interrupt request if the KBE.4 bit in KBE register is set.
Cleared by hardware after the read of the KBF register.
Keyboard line 3 flag
Set by hardware when the Port line 3 detects a programmed level. It generates a
Keyboard interrupt request if the KBE.3 bit in KBE register is set.
Cleared by hardware after the read of the KBF register.
Keyboard line 2 flag
Set by hardware when the Port line 2 detects a programmed level. It generates a
Keyboard interrupt request if the KBE.2 bit in KBE register is set.
Cleared by hardware after the read of the KBF register.
Keyboard line 1 flag
Set by hardware when the Port line 1 detects a programmed level. It generates a
Keyboard interrupt request if the KBE.1 bit in KBE register is set.
Cleared by hardware after the read of the KBF register.
Keyboard line 0 flag
Set by hardware when the Port line 0 detects a programmed level. It generates a
Keyboard interrupt request if the KBE.0 bit in KBE register is set.
Cleared by hardware after the read of the KBF register.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
156
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 95. Keyboard Input Enable Register - KBE (9Dh)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
KBE7
KBE6
KBE5
KBE4
KBE3
KBE2
KBE1
KBE0
Bit
Bit
Number
Mnemonic Description
Keyboard line 7 Enable bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
KBE7
KBE6
KBE5
KBE4
KBE3
KBE2
KBE1
KBE0
Cleared to enable standard I/O pin.
Set to enable KBF.7 bit in KBF register to generate an interrupt request.
Keyboard line 6 Enable bit
Cleared to enable standard I/O pin.
Set to enable KBF.6 bit in KBF register to generate an interrupt request.
Keyboard line 5 Enable bit
Cleared to enable standard I/O pin.
Set to enable KBF.5 bit in KBF register to generate an interrupt request.
Keyboard line 4 Enable bit
Cleared to enable standard I/O pin.
Set to enable KBF.4 bit in KBF register to generate an interrupt request.
Keyboard line 3 Enable bit
Cleared to enable standard I/O pin.
Set to enable KBF.3 bit in KBF register to generate an interrupt request.
Keyboard line 2 Enable bit
Cleared to enable standard I/O pin.
Set to enable KBF.2 bit in KBF register to generate an interrupt request.
Keyboard line 1 Enable bit
Cleared to enable standard I/O pin.
Set to enable KBF.1 bit in KBF register to generate an interrupt request.
Keyboard line 0 Enable bit
Cleared to enable standard I/O pin.
Set to enable KBF.0 bit in KBF register to generate an interrupt request.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
157
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 96. Keyboard Level Selector Register - KBLS (9Ch)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
KBLS7
KBLS6
KBLS5
KBLS4
KBLS3
KBLS2
KBLS1
KBLS0
Bit
Bit
Number Mnemonic Description
Keyboard line 7 Level Selection bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
KBLS7
KBLS6
KBLS5
KBLS4
KBLS3
KBLS2
KBLS1
KBLS0
Cleared to enable a low level detection on Port line 7.
Set to enable a high level detection on Port line 7.
Keyboard line 6 Level Selection bit
Cleared to enable a low level detection on Port line 6.
Set to enable a high level detection on Port line 6.
Keyboard line 5 Level Selection bit
Cleared to enable a low level detection on Port line 5.
Set to enable a high level detection on Port line 5.
Keyboard line 4 Level Selection bit
Cleared to enable a low level detection on Port line 4.
Set to enable a high level detection on Port line 4.
Keyboard line 3 Level Selection bit
Cleared to enable a low level detection on Port line 3.
Set to enable a high level detection on Port line 3.
Keyboard line 2 Level Selection bit
Cleared to enable a low level detection on Port line 2.
Set to enable a high level detection on Port line 2.
Keyboard line 1 Level Selection bit
Cleared to enable a low level detection on Port line 1.
Set to enable a high level detection on Port line 1.
Keyboard line 0 Level Selection bit
Cleared to enable a low level detection on Port line 0.
Set to enable a high level detection on Port line 0.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
158
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Interrupt System
Introduction
The AT8xC5122/23 implements an interrupt controller with 15 inputs but only 9 are used
for :
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
two external interrupts (INT0 and INT1)
two timer interrupts (timers 0, 1),
the UART interface
the SPI interface
the keyboard interface
the USB interface
the Smart Card Interface.
Interrupt System
Description
Each of the interrupt sources can be individually enabled or disabled by setting or clear-
ing a bit in the Interrupt Enable registers (Table 98 on page 162 and Table 99 on page
163). These registers also contain a global disable bit, which must be cleared to disable
all interrupts at once.
Each interrupt source can also be individually programmed to one out of four priority lev-
els by setting or clearing a bit in the Interrupt Priority Low registers (Table 101 on page
164 and Table 103 on page 166) and in the Interrupt Priority High register (Table 102 on
page 165 and Table 105 on page 168) shows the bit values and priority levels associ-
ated with each combination.
A low-priority interrupt can be interrupted by a high priority interrupt, but not by another
low-priority interrupt. A high-priority interrupt can’t be interrupted by any other interrupt
source.
If two interrupt requests of different priority levels are received simultaneously, the
request of higher priority level is serviced. If interrupt requests of the same priority level
are received simultaneously, an internal polling sequence determines which request is
serviced first. Thus within each priority level there is a second priority structure deter-
mined by the polling sequence.
Table 97. Priority Level Bit Values
IPH.x
IPL.x
Interrupt Level Priority
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0 (Lowest)
1
2
3 (Highest)
159
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 100. Interrupt Control System
Highest Priority
Interrupts
00
01
10
11
0
1
IE0
INT0#
TCON.1
EX0
IEN0.0
IT0
TCON.0
00
01
10
11
TF0
TCON.5
ET0
IEN0.1
RXD
RXIT
ISEL.4
RXEN
ISEL.0
00
01
10
11
1
0
1
INT1
IE1
0
TCON.3
EX1
IEN0.2
OELEV OEEN
IT1
TCON.2
ISEL.3
ISEL.2
0
1
CPRES
PRESIT
ISEL.5
CPLEV PRESEN
ISEL.7 ISEL.1
00
01
10
11
TF1
TCON.7
ET1
00
01
10
11
IEN0.3
RI
RXD
TXD
SERIAL
SCON.0
INTERFACE
CONTROLLER
TI
SCON.1
ES
IEN0.4
00
01
10
11
0
1
P5.x
KBFx
EKB (1)
IEN1.0
KBLSx
KBEx
MISO
MOSI
SCK
00
01
10
11
SPI
CONTROLLER
(1)
ESPI (1)
IEN1.2
00
01
10
11
SMART CARD
INTERFACE
CONTROLLER
CIO
CCLK
ESCI
IEN1.3
00
01
10
11
D+
D-
USB
CONTROLLER
EUSB
IEN1.6
EA
IEN0.7
IPH/L
note (1) : Not applicable to AT83C5123
Lowest Priority
Interrupts
Interrupt Enable
Priority Enable
160
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
INT1 Interrupt Vector
INT1 Input
The INT1 interrupt is multiplexed with the following three inputs:
•
•
•
INT1 : Standard 8051 interrupt input
RXD : Received data on UART
CPRES: Insertion or remove of the main card
The setting configurations for each input is detailed below.
This interrupt input is active under the following conditions :
•
•
•
It must be enabled by OEEN Bit (ISEL Register)
It can be active on a level or falling edge following IT1 Bit (TCON Register) status
If level triggering selection is set, the active level 0 or 1 can be selected with OELEV
Bit (ISEL Register)
The Bit IE1 (TCON Register) is set by hardware when external interrupt detected. It is
cleared when interrupt is processed.
RXD Input
A second vector interrupt input is the reception of a character. UART Rx input can gen-
erate an interrupt if enabled with Bit RXEN (ISEL.0). The global enable bits EX1 and EA
must also be set.
Then, the Bit RXIT (ISEL Register) is set by hardware when a low level is detected on
P3.0/RXD input.
CPRES Input
The third input is the detection of a level change on CPRES input (P1.2). This input can
generate an interrupt if enabled with PRESEN (ISEL.1) , EX1 (IE0.2) and EA (IE0.7)
Bits.
This detection is done according to the level selected with Bit CPLEV (ISEL.7).
Then the Bit PRESIT (ISEL.5) is set by hardware when the triggering conditions are
met. This Bit must be cleared by software.
161
4202D–SCR–06/05
Registers
Table 98. Interrupt Enable Register 0 - IEN0 (A8h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
EA
-
-
ES
ET1
EX1
ET0
EX0
Bit
Number
Bit
Mnemonic Description
Enable All interrupt bit
Cleared to disable all interrupts.
Set to enable all interrupts.
7
6 - 5
4
EA
-
Reserved
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
Serial port Enable bit
Cleared to disable serial port interrupt.
Set to enable serial port interrupt.
ES
Timer 1 overflow interrupt Enable bit
Cleared to disable timer 1 overflow interrupt.
Set to enable timer 1 overflow interrupt.
3
2
1
0
ET1
EX1
ET0
EX0
External interrupt 1 Enable bit
Cleared to disable external interrupt 1.
Set to enable external interrupt 1.
Timer 0 overflow interrupt Enable bit
Cleared to disable timer 0 overflow interrupt.
Set to enable timer 0 overflow interrupt.
External interrupt 0 Enable bit
Cleared to disable external interrupt 0.
Set to enable external interrupt 0.
Reset Value = 0000 0000b (Bit addressable)
162
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 99. Interrupt Enable Register 1 - IEN1 (B1h) for AT8xC5122
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
EUSB
-
-
ESCI
ESPI
-
EKB
Bit
Number
Bit
Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
USB Interrupt Enable bit
Cleared to disable USB interrupt .
Set to enable USB interrupt.
6
EUSB
-
Reserved
5 - 4
3
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
SCI interrupt Enable bit
ESCI
Cleared to disable SCIinterrupt .
Set to enable SCI interrupt.
SPI interrupt Enable bit
2
1
0
ESPI
-
Cleared to disable SPI interrupt .
Set to enable SPI interrupt.
Reserved
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Keyboard interrupt Enable bit
Cleared to disable keyboard interrupt .
Set to enable keyboard interrupt.
EKB
Reset Value = X0XX 00X0b (Bit addressable)
163
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 100. Interrupt Enable Register 1 - IEN1 (B1h) for AT83C5123
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
EUSB
-
-
ESCI
-
Bit
Number
Bit
Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
USB Interrupt Enable bit
Cleared to disable USB interrupt .
Set to enable USB interrupt.
6
EUSB
-
Reserved
5 - 4
3
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
SCI interrupt Enable bit
ESCI
Cleared to disable SCIinterrupt .
Set to enable SCI interrupt.
Reserved
2
1
0
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Reserved
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Reserved
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Reset Value = X0XX 0XXXb (Bit addressable)
Table 101. Interrupt Priority Low Register 0 - IPL0 (B8h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
PSL
PT1L
PX1L
PT0L
PX0L
Bit
Number
Bit
Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7 - 5
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
Serial port Priority bit
4
3
2
1
0
PSL
PT1L
PX1L
PT0L
PX0L
Refer to PSH for priority level.
Timer 1 overflow interrupt Priority bit
Refer to PT1H for priority level.
External interrupt 1 Priority bit
Refer to PX1H for priority level.
Timer 0 overflow interrupt Priority bit
Refer to PT0H for priority level.
External interrupt 0 Priority bit
Refer to PX0H for priority level.
Reset Value = X000 0000b (Bit addressable)
164
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 102. Interrupt Priority High Register 0 - IPH0 (B7h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
PSH
PT1H
PX1H
PT0H
PX0H
Bit
Bit
Number
Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7 - 5
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
Serial port Priority High bit
PSH
PSL
Priority Level
0
0
1
1
0
Lowest
4
PSH
PT1H
PX1H
PT0H
PX0H
1
0
1
Highest
Timer 1 overflow interrupt Priority High bit
PT1H
PT1L
Priority Level
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Lowest
3
2
1
0
Highest
External interrupt 1 Priority High bit
PX1H
PX1L
Priority Level
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Lowest
Highest
Timer 0 overflow interrupt Priority High bit
PT0H
PT0L
Priority Level
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Lowest
Highest
External interrupt 0 Priority High bit
PX0H
PX0L
Priority Level
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Lowest
Highest
Reset Value = X000 0000b (Not bit addressable)
165
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 103. Interrupt Priority Low Register 1 - IPL1 (B2h) for AT8xC5122
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
PUSBL
-
-
PSCIL
PSPIL
-
PKBDL
Bit
Number
Bit
Mnemonic Description
Reserved
-
7
6
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
USB Interrupt Priority bit
PUSBL
-
Refer to PUSBH for priority level.
Reserved
5 - 4
3
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
SCI Interrupt Priority bit
PSCIL
PSPIL
-
Refer to PSPIH for priority level.
SPI Interrupt Priority bit
2
Refer to PSPIH for priority level.
Reserved
1
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Keyboard Interrupt Priority bit
0
PKBL
Refer to PKBDH for priority level.
Reset Value = X00X 00X0b (Bit addressable)
166
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 104. Interrupt Priority Low Register 1 - IPL1 (B2h) for AT83C5123
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
PUSBL
-
-
PSCIL
Bit
Number
Bit
Mnemonic Description
Reserved
-
7
6
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
USB Interrupt Priority bit
PUSBL
-
Refer to PUSBH for priority level.
Reserved
5 - 4
3
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
SCI Interrupt Priority bit
PSCIL
Refer to PSPIH for priority level.
Reserved
2
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Reserved
1
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Reserved
0
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Reset Value = X0XX 0XXXb (Bit addressable)
167
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 105. Interrupt Priority High Register 1 - IPH1 (B3h) for AT8xC5122
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
PUSBH
-
-
PSCIH
-
Bit
Mnemonic
Bit
Number
Description
Reserved
7
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
USB Interrupt Priotity High bit
PUSBH PUSBL
Priority Level
Lowest
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
6
5-4
3
PUSBH
-
Highest
Reserved
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
SCI Interrupt Priority High bit
PSCIH
PSCIL
Priority Level
Lowest
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
PSCIH
Highest
SPI Interrupt Priority High bit
PSPIH
PSPIL
Priority Level
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Lowest
2
1
0
PSPIH
-
Highest
Reserved
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Keyboard Interrupt Priority High bit
PKBDH PKBDL
Priority Level
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Lowest
PKBH
Highest
Reset Value = XXXX X000b (Not bit addressable)
168
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 106. Interrupt Priority High Register 1 - IPH1 (B3h) for AT83C5123
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
PUSBH
-
-
PSCIH
-
-
-
Bit
Mnemonic
Bit
Number
Description
Reserved
7
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
USB Interrupt Priotity High bit
PUSBH PUSBL
Priority Level
Lowest
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
6
5-4
3
PUSBH
-
Highest
Reserved
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
SCI Interrupt Priority High bit
PSCIH
PSCIL
Priority Level
Lowest
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
PSCIH
Highest
Reserved
2
1
0
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
Reserved
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Reserved
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
Reset Value = X0XX 0XXXb (Not bit addressable)
169
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 107. Interrupt Enable Register - ISEL (S:A1h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CPLEV
-
PRESIT
RXIT
OELEV
OEEN
PRESEN
RXEN
Bit
Number
Bit
Mnemonic
Description
Card presence detection level
This bit indicates which CPRES level will bring about an interrupt
Set this bit to indicate that Card Presence IT will appear if CPRES is at high
level.
7
CPLEV
Clear this bit to indicate that Card Presence IT will appear if CPRES is at low
level.
Reserved
6
5
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Card presence detection interrupt flag
Set by hardware
PRESIT
Must be cleared by software
Received data interrupt flag
Set by hardware
Must be cleared by software
4
3
2
1
RXIT
OELEV
OEEN
INT1 signal active level
Set this bit to indicate that high level is active.
Clear this bit to indicate that low level is active.
INT1 Interrupt Disable bit
Clear to disable INT1 interrupt
Set to enable INT1 interrupt
Card presence detection Interrupt Enable bit
Clear to disable the card presence detection interrupt coming from SCIB.
Set to enable the card presence detection interrupt coming from SCIB.
PRESEN
Received data Interrupt Enable bit
Clear to disable the RxD interrupt.
Set to enable the RxD interrupt (a minimal bit width of 100 µs is required to
wake up from power-down) .
0
RXEN
Reset Value = 0000 0000b
170
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Interrupt Sources and
Vectors
Table 108. Interrupt Vectors
Vector
Address
Polling Priority
at Same Level
Interrupt Source
0
Reset
C:0000h
(Highest Priority)
INT0
1
2
C:0003h
C:000Bh
C:0013h
C:001Bh
C:0023h
C:002Bh
C:0033h
C:003Bh
C:0043h
C:004Bh
C:0053h
C:005Bh
C:0063h
C:006Bh
Timer 0
INT1
3
Timer 1
4
UART
6
Reserved
7
Reserved
5
Keyboard Controller (1)
8
Reserved
9
SPI Controller (1)
Smart Card Controller
Reserved
10
11
12
13
14
Reserved
USB Controller
15
Reserved
C:0073h
(Lowest Priority)
Note:
1. Only fot AT8xC5122
171
4202D–SCR–06/05
Microcontroller Reset
Introduction
The internal reset is used to start up (cold reset) or to re-start (warm reset) the micro-
controller activity. When the reset is applied (active state), all internal registers are
initialized so that the microcontroller starts from a known and clean state for the program
always runs as expected.
The reset is released (inactive state) when the following conditions are internally met :
–
–
–
The power supply has reatched a minimum level which garantees that the
microcontroller works properly
The on-chip oscillator has reached a minimum oscillation level which
ensures a good noise to signal ratio and a correct internal duty cycle
the active state duration is at least two machine cycles.
If one of the above conditions is not met the microcontroller is not correctly reset and
might not work properly.
The internal reset comes from four different sources :
–
–
–
–
Reset pin
Power On Reset (POR)
Power Fail Detector (PFD)
Hardware Watch-Dog Timer (WDT)
Figure 101. Reset bock diagram
VCore
3.3V Internal
Vcc
Digital Regulator
C51
POR
PFD
Core
Watch Dog
Timer
Internal Reset
RST
Microcontroller
172
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Power On Reset (POR)
The role of the POR is to monitor the power supply rise of the microcontroller core and
release the internal reset only when the internal voltage exceeds the VPFDP threshold
from which the microcontroller core is stable (see Figure 102). This feature replaces the
external reset function and therefore avoid the use of external components on the reset
pin.
Power Fail Detector
(PFD)
The role of the PFD is to monitor the power supply falls during a steady state condition
in order to suspend the microcontroller and peripherals activity as soon as the power
supply drops below the VPFDM threshold from which the microcontroller’s core might
become instable (see Figure 102). The PDF suspends the microcontroller’s activity by
holding the microcontroller under a reset state to avoid an unpredictable behaviour.
A filter prevents the system from reseting when glitches lower than 50 ns duration are
carried on Vcore. See Figure 102 and Figure 103 on page 174.
173
4202D–SCR–06/05
Figure 102. Static behaviour of POR and PFD
VCore
VPFDP
VPFDM
t
Internal
Reset
1
0
Figure 103. Dynamic behaviour of POR and PFD
VCore
VPFDP
VPFDM
t<50ns
t>50ns
t
Internal
Reset
1
0
174
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Reset pin
As explained in the POR section there is no need to use the reset pin as the internal
reset function at power up is ensured by the POR. Anyway, if some applications
requires a long reset, a reset controlled by the user or a reset controlled by external
superviser device, the use of the reset pin is necessary.
Long Reset
As the pad integrates an internal pull-up of 10K, only an external capacitor of at least 10
µF is required to have an impact on the reset duration.
Figure 104. Long Reset
Vcc
10 K
RST
Internal Reset
Microcontrolleur
10 µF
Reset Controlled by the User
The external capacitor is not needed if no long reset is required.
Figure 105. Reset Controlled by the User
Vcc
10 K
RST
Internal Reset
Microcontrolleur
175
4202D–SCR–06/05
Reset Controlled by an
As the reset pin can be forced in output by the Watch-Dog timer (WDT) or the POR/PFD
features, there can be a conflict between the external superviser device and the micro-
controller’s reset pin when in one side the external superviser is pulling the reset pin to
VCC and in another side the WDT or POR/PFD features tries to force the reset pin to
ground. Therefore, it recommended to insert a series resistor of 1.8K +/-10% or a diode
(1N4148 for instance) between the external superviser device and the reset pin as
detailed in the following figures.
External Superviser Device
Figure 106. Use of an External Serial Resistor
Microcontrolleur
Vcc
Power On
Reset
10 K
RST
1.8 K
Power Fail
Detector
Superviser
device
Watchdog
Timer
To other on-board
circuitry
Figure 107. Use of an External Diode
Microcontrolleur
Vcc
Power On
Reset
10 K
1N4148
RST
Power Fail
Detector
Superviser
device
Watchdog
Timer
To other on-board
circuitry
176
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Watchdog Timer
The AT8xC5122/23 microcontrollers contain a powerfull programmable hardware
Watchdog Timer (WDT) that automatically resets the chip if its software fails to reset the
WDT before the selected time interval has elapsed. It permits large timeout ranking from
4ms to 524ms @ FCK_WD = 24 MHz / X2
This WDT consist of a 14-bit counter plus a 7-bit programmable counter, a Watchdog
Timer reset register (WDTRST) and a Watchdog Timer programmation (WDTPRG) reg-
ister. When exiting the reset, the WDT is, by default, disabled. To activate the WDT, the
user has to write the sequence 1EH and E1H into WDRST register. When the Watchdog
Timer is enabled, it will increment every machine cycle while the oscillator is running
and there is no way to disable the WDT except through reset (either hardware reset or
WDT overflow reset). When WDT overflows, it will generate an output RESET pulse at
the RST pin. The RESET pulse duration is 96xTOSC, where TOSC=1/FOSC. To make the
best use of the WDT, it should be serviced in those sections of code that will periodically
be executed within the time required to prevent a WDT reset.
The WDT is controlled by two registers (WDTRST and WDTPRG).
Figure 108. Watchdog Timer
Decoder
RESET
WR
Control
WDTRST
Enable
14-bit COUNTER
7 - bit COUNTER
Outputs
FCK_WD
-
-
-
-
0
-
1
2
WDTPRG
RESET
177
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 109. Watchdog Timer Out Register - WDTPRG (0A7h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
-
-
S2
S1
S0
Bit
Number
Bit
Mnemonic Description
Reserved
7 - 3
-
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change these bits.
2
1
0
S2
S1
S0
WDT Time-out select bit 2
WDT Time-out select bit 1
WDT Time-out select bit 0
Reset Value = XXXX X000b
The three lower bits (S0, S1, S2) located into WDTPRG register enables to program the
WDT duration.
Table 110. Machine Cycle Count
S2
S1
S0
0
Machine Cycle Count
214 - 1
0
0
0
0
1
215 - 1
0
1
0
216 - 1
0
1
1
217 - 1
1
0
0
218 - 1
1
0
1
219 - 1
1
1
0
220 - 1
1
1
1
221 - 1
To compute WD Timeout, the following formula must be applied:
Time Out = 6 * (214 * 2 Svalue - 1 ) / FCK_WD
Note:
Svalue represents the decimal value of (S2 S1 S0)
178
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table 111. Timeout value for FCK_WD = 24 MHz / X2
S2
0
S1
0
S0
0
Timeout for FCK_WD= 24 MHz / X2
4.10 ms
8.19 ms
0
0
1
0
1
0
16.38 ms
32.77 ms
65.54 ms
131.07 ms
262.14 ms
524.29 ms
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
1
1
0
1
1
1
Table 112. Watchdog Timer Enable register (Write Only) - WDTRST (A6h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Reset Value = XXXX XXXXb
The WDTRST register is used to reset / enable the WDT by writing 1EH then E1H in
sequence.
179
4202D–SCR–06/05
Power Management
Before activating the Idle Mode or Power Down Mode, the CPU clock must be switched
to on-chip oscillator source if the PLL is used to fed the CPU clock.
Idle Mode
An instruction that sets PCON.0 indicates that it is the last instruction to be executed
before going into the Idle mode. In the Idle mode, the internal clock signal is gated off to
the CPU, but not to the interrupt, Timer, and Serial Port functions. The CPU status is
preserved in its entirety: the Stack Pointer, Program Counter, Program Status Word,
Accumulator and all other registers maintain their data during Idle. The port pins hold
the logical states they had at the time Idle was activated. ALE and PSEN hold at logic
high level.
There are two ways to terminate the Idle mode. Activation of any enabled interrupt will
cause PCON.0 to be cleared by hardware, terminating the Idle mode. The interrupt will
be serviced, and following RETI the next instruction to be executed will be the one fol-
lowing the instruction that put the device into idle.
The flag bits GF0 and GF1 can be used to give an indication if an interrupt occured dur-
ing normal operation or during an Idle. For example, an instruction that activates Idle
can also set one or both flag bits. When Idle is terminated by an interrupt, the interrupt
service routine can examine the flag bits.
The other way of terminating the Idle mode is with a hardware reset. Since the clock
oscillator is still running, the hardware reset needs to be held active for only two
machine cycles (24 oscillator periods) to complete the reset.
Power Down Mode
To save maximum power, a power-down mode can be invoked by software (see Table
13, PCON register).
WARNING: To minimize power consumption, all peripherals and I/Os with static current
consumption must be set in the proper state. I/Os programmed with low speed output
configuration (KB_OUT) must be switch to push-pull or Standard C51 configuration
before entering power-down. The CVCC generator must also be switch off.
In power-down mode, the oscillator is stopped and the instruction that invoked power-
down mode is the last instruction executed. The internal RAM and SFRs retain their
value until the power-down mode is terminated. VCC can be lowered to save further
power. Either a hardware reset or an external interrupt can cause an exit from power-
down. To properly terminate power-down, the reset or external interrupt should not be
executed before VCC is restored to its normal operating level and must be held active
long enough for the oscillator to restart and stabilize.
Only external interrupts INT0 , INT1, Keyboard, Card insertion/removal and USB Inter-
rupts are useful to exit from power-down. For that, interrupt must be enabled and
configured as level or edge sensitive interrupt input. When Keyboard Interrupt occurs
after a power-down mode, 1024 clocks are necessary to exit to power-down mode and
enter in operating mode.
Holding the pin low restarts the oscillator but bringing the pin high completes the exit as
detailed in Figure 109. When both interrupts are enabled, the oscillator restarts as soon
as one of the two inputs is held low and power-down exit will be completed when the first
input is released. In this case, the higher priority interrupt service routine is executed.
Once the interrupt is serviced, the next instruction to be executed after RETI will be the
one following the instruction that put AT8xC5122/23 into power-down mode.
180
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 109. Power-down Exit Waveform
INT0
INT1
XTAL1
Active phase
Power-down phase
Oscillator restart phase
Active phase
Exit from power-down by reset redefines all the SFRs, exit from power-down by external
interrupt does no affect the SFRs.
Exit from power-down by either reset or external interrupt does not affect the internal
RAM content.
Note:
If idle mode is activated with power-down mode (IDL and PD bits set), the exit sequence
is unchanged, when execution is vectored to interrupt, PD and IDL bits are cleared and
idle mode is not entered.
Table shows the state of ports during idle and power-down modes.
Table State of Ports
Mode
Program Memory
ALE
PSEN
P0
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
Idle
Internal
External
Internal
External
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
Port Data(1)
Floating
Port Dat*
Floating
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Address
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Port Data
Idle
Power-down
Power-down
Note:
1. Port 0 can force a 0 level. A "one" will leave port floating.
Reduced EMI Mode
The ALE signal is used to demultiplex address and data buses on port 0 when used with
external program or data memory. Nevertheless, during internal code execution, ALE
signal is still generated. In order to reduce EMI, ALE signal can be disabled by setting
AO bit.
The AO bit is located in AUXR register at bit location 0. As soon as AO is set, ALE is no
longer output but remains active during MOVX and MOVC instructions and external
fetches. During ALE disabling, ALE pin is weakly pulled high.
181
4202D–SCR–06/05
USB Interface
Suspend
The Suspend state can be detected by the USB controller if all the clocks are enabled
and if the USB controller is enabled. The bit SPINT is set by hardware when an idle
state is detected for more than 3 ms. This triggers a USB interrupt if enabled.
In order to reduce current consumption, the firmware can put the USB PAD in idle mode,
stop the clocks and put the C51 in Idle or Power-down mode. The Resume detection is
still active.
The USB PAD is put in idle mode when the firmware clear the SPINT bit. In order to
avoid a new suspend detection 3ms later, the firmware has to disable the USB clock
input using the SUSPCLK bit in the USBCON Register. The USB PAD automatically
exits of idle mode when a wake-up event is detected.
The stop of the 48 MHz clock from the PLL should be done in the following order:
1. Disable of the 48 MHz clock input of the USB controller by setting to 1 the SUS-
PCLK bit in the USBCON register.
2. If CPU clock is fed from PLL, the on-chip oscillator must be selected to fed the
CPU clock.
3. Disable the PLL by clearing the PLLEN bit in the PLLCON register.
Resume
When the USB controller is in Suspend state, the Resume detection is active even if all
the clocks are disabled and if the C51 is in Idle or Power-down mode. The WUPCPU bit
is set by hardware when a non-idle state occurs on the USB bus. This triggers an inter-
rupt if enabled. This interrupt wakes up the CPU from its Idle or Power-down state and
the interrupt function is then executed. The firmware will first enable the 48 MHz gener-
ation and then reset to 0 the SUSPCLK bit in the USBCON register if needed.
The firmware has to clear the SPINT bit in the USBINT register before any other USB
operation in order to wake up the USB controller from its Suspend mode.
The USB controller is then re-activated.
182
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Figure 110. Example of a Suspend/Resume Management
USB Controller Init
SPINT
Detection of a SUSPEND State
Put the USB pads
Clear SPINT
in power down mode
Set SUSPCLK
Disable PLL
microcontroller in power-down
WUPCPU
Detection of a RESUME State
Clear SUSPCLK
Note :
WUPCPU bit must be
Cleared before enabling
the PLL
Clear WUPCPU bit
Enable PLL
Smart Card Interface
Entering in Power-down Mode In order to reduce the power consumption, a power-down or idle mode can be invoked
by software (see Table 13, PCON register). Before activating these modes the applica-
tion will need to:
Power-off the Smart Card Interface by applying the following sequence:
•
•
Set CRST pin at low level by clearing the bit CARDRST in SCCON register.
Set CCLK pin at low level by clearing the bit CLK then the CARDCLK in SCCON
register.
•
•
Set CIO pin at low level by clearing the bit UART in SCICR register then the bit
CARDIO in SCCON register.
Power the Smart Interface off by clearing the CARDVCC bit in SCCON register. This
instruction enables to switch DC/DC converter off.
CPRES input:
•
•
•
•
•
Set the bit PRSEN in ISEL register
Set the bit EX1 in IE0 register
Set the bit EA in the IE0 register
Invert the bit CPLEV in ISEL register (INT1 interrupt vector)
Clear the bit PRESIT in the ISEL register
Exiting from Power-down
Mode
The microcontroller will exit from Power-down or Idle modes upon a reset or INT1 inter-
rupt which is a multiplexing of the interruptions generated by the CPRES pin (Card
detection), RxD flag (UART reception) and INT1 pin.
183
4202D–SCR–06/05
Keyboard Interface
The keyboard interface applies only to AT8xC5122 version.
Entering in Power-down Mode In order to reduce the power consumption, the microcontroller can be set in power-down
or idle mode by software (see Table 13, PCON register). Before activating these modes
the application will need to configure the keyboard interface as follows:
•
Set all keyboard’s ouputs pins KB Rx at low level by writing a 0 on the ports. This
operation has a double effect:
–
–
any key that is pressed generates an interrupt capable of waking-up the
microcontroller,
Set all bits KBE.x in KBE registers to enable interrupts.
Exiting from Power-down
Mode
The microcontroller will exit from Power-down Mode upon a reset or any interrupt gener-
ated by a key press. Note that 1024 clocks are necessary to exit from power-down mode
when a keyboard interrupt occurs. This means that there will be a delay between the
time at which the key is pressed and the time at which the application is able to identify
the key.
Watchdog Timer during
Power-down and Idle
Mode
In Power-down mode the oscillator stops, which means the WDT also stops. While in
Power-down mode the user does not need to service the WDT. There are 2 methods of
exiting Power-down mode : by a hardware reset or by a level activated external interrupt
which is enabled prior to entering power-down mode. When Power-down is exited with
hardware reset, servicing the WDT should occur as it normally does whenever
AT8xC5122D is reset. Exiting Power-down with an interrupt is significantly different. The
interrupt is held low long enough for the oscillator to stabilize. When the interrupt is
brought high, the interrupt is serviced. To prevent the WDT from resetting the device
while the interrupt pin is held low, the WDT is not started until the interrupt is pulled high.
It is suggested that the WDT be reset during the interrupt service for the interrupt used
to exit Power-down.
To ensure that the WDT does not overflow within a few states of exiting of powerdown, it
is best to reset the WDT just before entering powerdown.
In the Idle mode, the oscillator continues to run. To prevent the WDT from resetting
while the microcontroller is in Idle mode, the user should always set up a timer that will
periodically exit Idle, service the WDT, and re-enter Idle mode.
184
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Registers
Table 113. Power Control Register - PCON (S:87h)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
SMOD1
SMOD0
-
POF
GF1
GF0
PD
IDL
Bit
Bit
Number
Mnemonic Description
Serial port Mode bit 1 for UART
Set to select double baud rate in mode 1,2 or 3
7
6
5
SMOD1
SMOD0
-
Serial port Mode bit 0 for UART
Cleared to select SM0 bit in SCON register
Set to select FE bit in SCON register
Reserved
The value read from this bit is indeterminate. Do not change this bit.
Power-Off Flag (Only for ROM version parts)
Cleared to recognize next reset type
Set by hardware when VCC rises from 0 to its nominal voltage. Can also be set
by software
4
POF
Warning : in CRAM and FLASH versions, this bit is reserved.
General purpose Flag
Cleared by user for general-purpose usage
Set by user for general-purpose usage
3
2
1
0
GF1
GF0
PD
General purpose Flag
Cleared by user for general-purpose usage
Set by user for general-purpose usage
Power-Down mode bit
Cleared by hardware when reset occurs
Set to enter power-down mode
Idle mode bit
Cleared by hardware when interrupt or reset occurs
IDL
Set to enter idle mode
Reset Value = 00X1 0000b
Power-off flag reset value will be 1 only after a power on (cold reset). A warm reset
doesn’t affect the value of this bit.
185
4202D–SCR–06/05
Electrical Characteristics
Absolute Maximum Ratings
Note:
Stresses at or above those listed under “Absolute
Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent damage to
the device. This is a stress rating only and functional
operation of the device at these or any other condi-
tions above those indicated in the operational
sections of this specification is not implied. Exposure
to absolute maximum rating conditions may affect
device reliability.
Ambiant Temperature Under Bias ......................-25°C to 85°C
Storage Temperature.................................... -65°C to + 150°C
Voltage on VCC to VSS ......................................-0.5 V to + 6.0V
Voltage on Any Pin to VSS........................-0.5 V to VCC + 0.5 V
Power Dissipation 1 W
Power Dissipation value is based on the maximum
allowable die temperature and the thermal resistance
of the package.
DC Parameters
TA = -40 to +85°C; VSS = 0 V, FCK_CPU= 0 to 24 MHz , VCC = 3.6V to 5.5V
Symbol
VIL
Parameter
Min
-0.5
Typ
Max
0.2 VCC - 0.1
VCC + 0.5
VCC + 0.5
0.45
Unit
V
Test Conditions
Input Low Voltage
VIH
Input High Voltage except XTAL1, RST
Input High Voltage, XTAL1, RST
Output Low Voltage: P0, ALE, PSEN
Output High Voltage: P0, ALE, PSEN
0.2 VCC + 0.9
0.7 VCC
V
VIH1
VOL
V
V
IOL = 1.6 mA
IOH = 10 µA
VOH
0.9 VCC
0.9 VCC
V
Output Low Voltage: P2, P3, P4, P5, P1.2, P1.6,
P1.7
VOL1
0.45
V
V
IOL = 0.8 mA
Output High Voltage: P2, P3, P4, P5, P1.2, P1.6,
P1.7
VOH1
IOH = -10 µA
Logical 0 Input Current ports 2 to 5 and P1.2, P1.6,
P1.7, if Weak pull-up enabled
IIL
ILI
ITL
-50
±10
µA
µA
µA
Vin = 0.45 V
Input Leakage Current
0.45 V < VIN < VCC
Logical 1 to O transistion Current, Port 51
configuration
−650
VIN = 2 V
RMEDIUM
RWEAK
Medium Pullup Resistor
Weak Pullup Resistor
10
kΩ
kΩ
100
Fc = 1MHz
CIO
Capacitance of I/O Buffer
10
3.6
10
3
pF
V
TA = 25°C
DVCC
DICC
Digital Supply Voltage
3
3.4
CL = 470 nF
CL = 100 nF
Digital Supply Output Current (DVcc pin)
mA
F
CK_CPU = 24 MHz
VPFDP
VPFDM
rise, tfall
Power Fail High Level Threshold
Power Fail Low Level Threshold
VDD rise and fall time
2.8
2.6
V
V
2,5
t
1µs
600
second
186
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Symbol
RRST
Parameter
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
Test Conditions
Internal reset pull-up resistor
5
10
30
k
Ω
60µA
40µA
200µA
200µA
Vcc = 5.5V
Vcc = 3.6V
Power down consumption
IPD
ICCIDLE
Power Supply current in IDLE mode
0.4*F+2
1.6*F+3
mA
mA
Vcc = 5.5V (F in MHz)
Vcc = 5.5V (F in MHz)
Power Supply current in Active mode
(AT89C5122) with DC/DC ON
ICCOP
Power Supply current in Active mode
(AT85C5122) with DC/DC ON
1.6*F+3
1.6*F+2
1.6*F+4
0.8*F+3
0.8*F+3
0.8*F+2
0.8*F+4
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
Vcc = 5.5V (F in MHz)
Vcc = 5.5V (F in MHz)
Vcc = 5.5V (F in MHz)
Vcc = 5.5V (F in MHz)
Vcc = 5.5V (F in MHz)
Vcc = 5.5V (F in MHz)
Vcc = 5.5V (F in MHz)
ICCOP
Power Supply current in Active mode
(AT83C5122) with DC/DC ON
ICCOP
Power Supply current in Active mode
(AT89C5122) Flash or E2PROM write DC/DC ON
ICCWRITE
Power Supply current in Active mode
(AT89C5122) with DC/DC OFF
ICCOP
Power Supply current in Active mode
(AT85C5122) with DC/DC FF
ICCOP
Power Supply current in Active mode
(AT83C5122) with DC/DC OFF
ICCOP
Power Supply current in Active mode
(AT89C5122) Flash or E2PROM write DC/DC OFF
ICCWRITE
187
4202D–SCR–06/05
ICC Current Test Conditions
Figure 111. Power Down Mode
All other pins are disconnected.
VCC
Ipd
LI
VCC
AVCC
VCC
P0
VCC
EA
(NC)
XTAL2
XTAL1
PLLF
GND
Vss
AVss
GND
GND
GND
Figure 112. Active and Idle Mode
All other pins are disconnected.
VCC
Icc
LI
VCC
VCC
AVCC
P0
VCC
EA
(NC)
CLOCK SIGNAL
XTAL2
XTAL1
PLLF
Vss
AVss
GND
GND
GND
LED’s
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Typ
Max
Unit Test Conditions
1
2
5
3
6
10
5
8
20
mA 2 mA configuration
mA 4 mA configuration
mA 10 mA configuration
IOL
Output Low Current, P3.6 and P3.7 LED modes
Note:
1. (TA = -20°C to +50°C, VCC - VOL = 2 V )
188
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Smart Card Interface
Card VCC 5V (for IEC7816-3 Class A cards)
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Typ
Max
Unit Test Conditions
Vcc
Power Supply
4.0
5.5
V
CICC_ovf
CVCC
Card Supply Current overflow
Card Supply Voltage
Ripple on Card Voltage
100
mA
4.6
4.5
5.4
V
CICC = 60 mA
200
mV 0 < CIcc < 60 mA
Max. charge 20 nA.s
Max. duration 400 ns
Max. variation CICC 100 mA
CVCC
TOFF
TON
Card Supply Voltage during spike on Icc
5.5
750
750
Cload=10µF, Lload=10µH
Vcard = CVcc to 0.4V
CVcc to 0
0 to CVcc
µs
Cload=10µF, Lload=10µH
Vcard = 0V to CVcc
With Boost at 60%
µs
Card VCC 3V Power Supply (for IEC7816-3 Class B cards)
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Typ
Max
Unit Test Conditions
Vcc
Power Supply
3.6
5.5
V
CICC_ovf
CVCC
Card Supply Current overflow
Card Supply Voltage
Ripple on Vcard
100
mA
2.76
2.7
3.24
200
V
CICC = 60 mA
mV 0 < CICC < 60 mA
Maxi. charge 10nA.s
CVCC
TOFF
TON
Card Supply Voltage during spike on Icc
3.3
750
750
V
Max. duration 400 ns
Max. variation CICC 50mA
Cload=10µF, Lload=10µH
Vcard = CVcc to 0.4V
CVcc to 0
0 to CVcc
µs
µs
Cload=10µF, Lload=10µH
Vcard = 0V to CVcc
With Boost at 60%
189
4202D–SCR–06/05
Card VCC 1.8V Power Supply (for IEC7816-3 Class C cards)
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Typ
Max
Unit Test Conditions
Vcc
Power Supply
3.6
5.5
V
CICC_ovf
CVCC
Card Supply Current overflow
Card Supply Voltage
100
mA
1.68
1.92
750
V
CICC = 30 mA
Cload=10µF, Lload=10µH
Vcard = CVcc to 0.4V
TOFF
CVcc to 0
0 to CVcc
µs
Cload=10µF, Lload=10µH
Vcard = 0V to CVcc
With Boost at 60%
TON
750
µs
Notes: 1. Test conditions, Capacitor 10 µF, Inductance 10 µH.
2. Ceramic X7R, SMD type capacitor with minimum ESR or 250 m
Ω
is mandatory
Smart Card CCLK, DC parameters
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
Test Conditions
0(1)
0(1)
0.2xVCC
0.4
V
IOL = 20 µΑ (1.8V, 3V)
IOL= 50 µA (5V)
VOL
Output Low Voltage
Output Low Current
IOL
15
mA
0.7 CVCC
0.7 CVCC
0.7 CVCC
CVCC - 0.5
CVCC
CVCC
CVCC
CVCC
V
V
V
V
IOH = 20 µA (1.8V)
IOH = 20 µA (3V)
IOH = 20 µA (5V)
IOH = 50 µA (5V)
VOH
Output High Voltage
IOH
Output High Current
Rise and Fall delays
Voltage Stability
15
mA
16
22.5
50
CIN=30pF (5V)
CIN=30pF (3V)
CIN=30pF (1.8V)
tR tF
ns
V
-0.25
CVCC-0.5
0.4 CVCC
CVCC + 0.25
Low level
High level
Frequency variation
Cycle ratio
1%
45%
55%
Notes: 1. The voltage on CLK should remain between -0.3V and VCC+0.3V during dynamic operation.
Smart Card CIO, DC Parameters
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
Test Conditions
0(1)
0(1)
0.5
0.15 CVCC
IIL= 500 µA
IIL = 20 µA
VIL
Input Low Voltage
V
IIL
Input Low Current
Input High Voltage
Input High Current
500
CVCC
µA
V
VIH
IIH
0.7 CVCC
IIH = -20 µA
-20 / +20
µA
0.4
0.4
0.3
IOL = 1mA (5V)
IOL = 1mA (3V)
IOL = 1mA (1.8V)
VOL
Output Low Voltage
0(1)
V
190
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Smart Card CIO, DC Parameters
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
Test Conditions
IOL
Output Low Current
15
mA
0.8 CVCC
0.7 CVCC
IOH = 20 µA (5V)
IOH = 20 µA (3V, 1.8V)
VOH
IOH
Output High Voltage
Output High Current
Voltage Stability
CVCC (1)
15
V
mA
V
-0.25
0.8 CVCC
0.4
CVCC + 0.25
Low level
High level
tR tF
Rise and Fall delays
0.8
µs
CIN=30pF.
Note:
1. The voltage on RST should remain between -0.3V and VCC+0.3V during dynamic operation.
Smart Card RST, CC4, CC8, DC Parameters
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
V
Test Conditions
0(1)
0(1)
0.12 x VCC
0.4
I
OL = 20 µΑ
VOL
Output Low Voltage
Output Low Current
Output High Voltage
IOL= 50 µΑ
IOL
15
mA
V
CVCC - 0.5
0.8 x VCC
CVCC
CVCC
IOH = 50 µΑ
IOH = 20 µΑ
VOH
(1)
IOH
Output High Current
Rise and Fall delays
Voltage Stability
15
mA
tR tF
0.8
µs
CIN=30 pF
-0.25
0.4 x CVCC
Low level
High level
CVCC-0.5
CVCC + 0.25
Note:
1. The voltage on RST should remain between -0.3V and VCC+0.3V during dynamic operation.
Card Presence (P1.2) DC Parameters
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Typ
Max
Unit
Test Conditions
P1.2=1, short to VSS
Pull-up enabled
IOL1
CPRES weak pull-up output current
3
10
25
µA
191
4202D–SCR–06/05
USB Interface
Figure 113. USB Interface
Symbol
Parameter
Min
3.0
2.0
2.7
Typ(5)
Max
3.6
4.0
3.6
0.8
3.6
0.3
Unit
V
USB Reference Voltage
VREF
VIH
Input High Voltage for D+ and D- (driven)
Input High Voltage for D+ and D- (floating)
Input Low Voltage for D+ and D-
Output High Voltage for D+ and D-
Output Low Voltage for D+ and D-
V
VIHZ
VIL
V
V
VOH
VOL
2.8
0.0
V
V
192
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
AC Parameters
Explanation of the AC
Symbols
Each timing symbol has 5 characters. The first character is always a “T” (stands for
time). The other characters, depending on their positions, stand for the name of a signal
or the logical status of that signal. The following is a list of all the characters and what
they stand for.
Example:TAVLL = Time for Address Valid to ALE Low.
T
LLPL = Time for ALE Low to PSEN Low.
TA = -40°C to +85°C; VSS = 0V; VCC = 3.6V to 5.5V ; FCK_CPU = 0 to 24 MHz.
(Load Capacitance for port 0, ALE and PSEN = 60 pF; Load Capacitance for all other
outputs = 60 pF.)
Table and Table 118 give the description of each AC symbols.
Table 117 and Table 120 give for each range the AC parameter.
Table 115, Table 117 and Table 119 give the frequency derating formula of the AC
parameter for each speed range description. To calculate each AC symbols. take the x
value and use this value in the formula.
Example: TLLIV and 20 MHz, Standard clock.
x = 30 ns
T = 50 ns
T
CCIV = 4T - x = 170 ns
External Program Memory
Characteristics
Table 114. Symbol Description
Symbol
Parameter
T
CPU clock period (FCK_CPU
ALE pulse width
)
TLHLL
TAVLL
TLLAX
TLLIV
TLLPL
TPLPH
TPLIV
TPXIX
TPXIZ
TAVIV
TPLAZ
Address Valid to ALE
Address Hold After ALE
ALE to Valid Instruction In
ALE to PSEN
PSEN Pulse Width
PSEN to Valid Instruction In
Input Instruction Hold After PSEN
Input Instruction Float After PSEN
Address to Valid Instruction In
PSEN Low to Address Float
193
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 115. AC Parameters for a Variable Clock
Standard
Symbol
TLHLL
TAVLL
TLLAX
TLLIV
Type
Min
clock
2T - x
T - x
T - x
4T - x
T - x
3T - x
3T - x
x
X2 Clock
T - x
X parameter
Units
ns
15
20
20
35
15
25
45
0
Min
0.5 T - x
0.5 T - x
2 T - x
0.5 T - x
1.5 T - x
1.5 T - x
x
ns
Min
ns
Max
Min
ns
TLLPL
TPLPH
TPLIV
ns
Min
ns
Max
Min
ns
TPXIX
TPXIZ
TAVIV
ns
Max
Max
Max
T - x
5T - x
x
0.5 T - x
2.5 T - x
x
15
45
10
ns
ns
TPLAZ
ns
External Program Memory
Read Cycle
12 TCLCL
TLHLL
TLLIV
TLLPL
ALE
TPLPH
TPXAV
PSEN
TLLAX
TAVLL
TPLIV
TPLAZ
TPXIZ
TPXIX
INSTR IN
A0-A7
A0-A7
INSTR IN
INSTR IN
PORT 0
TAVIV
ADDRESS A8-A15
ADDRESS
PORT 2
ADDRESS A8-A15
OR SFR-P2
194
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
External Data Memory
Characteristics
Table 116. Symbol Description
Symbol
TRLRH
TWLWH
TRLDV
TRHDX
TRHDZ
TLLDV
Parameter
RD Pulse Width
WR Pulse Width
RD to Valid Data In
Data Hold After RD
Data Float After RD
ALE to Valid Data In
Address to Valid Data In
ALE to WR or RD
TAVDV
TLLWL
TAVWL
TQVWX
TQVWH
TWHQX
TRLAZ
Address to WR or RD
Data Valid to WR Transition
Data set-up to WR High
Data Hold After WR
RD Low to Address Float
RD or WR High to ALE high
TWHLH
195
4202D–SCR–06/05
Table 117. AC Parameters for a Variable Clock
Standard
Symbol
TRLRH
TWLWH
TRLDV
TRHDX
TRHDZ
TLLDV
Type
Min
Min
Max
Min
Max
Max
Max
Min
Max
Min
Min
Min
Min
Max
Min
Max
Clock
6T - x
6T - x
5T - x
x
X2 Clock
3 T - x
3 T - x
2.5 T - x
x
X parameter
Units
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
20
20
25
0
2T - x
8T - x
9T - x
3T - x
3T + x
4T - x
T - x
T - x
20
40
60
25
25
25
15
25
10
0
4T - x
TAVDV
TLLWL
4.5 T - x
1.5 T - x
1.5 T + x
2 T - x
0.5 T - x
3.5 T - x
0.5 T - x
x
TLLWL
TAVWL
TQVWX
TQVWH
TWHQX
TRLAZ
TWHLH
TWHLH
7 T - x
T - x
x
T - x
0.5 T - x
0.5 T + x
15
15
T - x
(warning x value differ from AT89C51RD2)
External Data Memory Write
Cycle
TWHLH
ALE
PSEN
WR
TLLWL
TWLWH
TQVWX
TWHQX
TLLAX
A0-A7
TQVWH
PORT 0
PORT 2
DATA OUT
TAVWL
ADDRESS
ADDRESS A8-A15 OR SFR P2
OR SFR-P2
196
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
External Data Memory Read
Cycle
TWHLH
TLLDV
ALE
PSEN
RD
TLLWL
TRLRH
TRHDZ
TAVDV
TLLAX
TRHDX
PORT 0
PORT 2
A0-A7
DATA IN
TRLAZ
TAVWL
ADDRESS
ADDRESS A8-A15 OR SFR P2
OR SFR-P2
Serial Port Timing - Shift
Register Mode
Table 118. Symbol Description (F = 40 MHz)
Symbol
TXLXL
Parameter
Serial port clock cycle time
TQVHX
TXHQX
TXHDX
TXHDV
Output data set-up to clock rising edge
Output data hold after clock rising edge
Input data hold after clock rising edge
Clock rising edge to input data valid
Table 119. AC Parameters for a Variable Clock
Standard
Symbol
TXLXL
Type
Min
Min
Min
Min
Max
Clock
X2 Clock
6 T
X parameter
Units
ns
12T
TQVHX
TXHQX
TXHDX
TXHDV
10T - x
2T - x
x
5 T - x
T - x
50
20
0
ns
ns
x
ns
10T - x
5 T- x
133
ns
197
4202D–SCR–06/05
Shift Register Timing
Waveform
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
INSTRUCTION
ALE
TXLXL
CLOCK
TXHQX
1
TQVXH
0
2
3
4
5
6
7
OUTPUT DATA
TXHDX
SET TI
TXHDV
WRITE to SBUF
INPUT DATA
VALID
VALID
VALID
VALID
VALID
VALID
VALID
VALID
SET RI
CLEAR RI
External Clock Drive
Characteristics (XTAL1)
Table 120. AC Parameters
Symbol
TCLCL
Parameter
Oscillator Period
High Time
Low Time
Min
Max
Units
ns
125
5
TCHCX
TCLCX
TCLCH
TCHCL
ns
5
ns
Rise Time
5
5
ns
Fall Time
ns
T
CHCX/TCLCX Cyclic ratio in X2 mode
40
60
%
External Clock Drive
Waveforms
VCC-0.5V
0.7VCC
0.2VCC-0.1
0.45V
TCHCX
TCLCH
TCLCX
TCHCL
TCLCL
AC Testing Input/Output
Waveforms
VCC -0.5V
0.2 VCC + 0.9
0.2 VCC - 0.1
INPUT/OUTPUT
0.45V
AC inputs during testing are driven at VCC - 0.5 for a logic “1” and 0.45V for a logic “0”.
Timing measurement are made at VIH min for a logic “1” and VIL max for a logic “0”.
198
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Float Waveforms
FLOAT
VLOAD
VOH - 0.1 V
VOL + 0.1 V
VLOAD + 0.1 V
LOAD - 0.1 V
V
For timing purposes as port pin is no longer floating when a 100 mV change from load
voltage occurs and begins to float when a 100 mV change from the loaded VOH/VOL level
occurs. IOL/IOH ≥ ± 20 mA.
Clock Waveforms
Valid in normal clock mode. In X2 mode XTAL2 must be changed to XTAL2/2.
STATE4
P1 P2
STATE5
P1 P2
STATE6
P1 P2
STATE1
STATE2
P1 P2
STATE3
P1 P2
STATE4
P1 P2
STATE5
P1 P2
INTERNAL
CLOCK
XTAL2
P1
P2
ALE
THESE SIGNALS ARE NOT ACTIVATED DURING THE
EXECUTION OF A MOVX INSTRUCTION
EXTERNAL PROGRAM MEMORY FETCH
PSEN
P0
DATA
PCL OUT
DATA
PCL OUT
DATA
PCL OUT
SAMPLED
SAMPLED
SAMPLED
FLOAT
FLOAT
FLOAT
P2 (EXT)
INDICATES ADDRESS TRANSITIONS
READ CYCLE
RD
PCL OUT (IF PROGRAM
MEMORY IS EXTERNAL)
DPL OR Rt OUT
DATA
P0
SAMPLED
FLOAT
P2
INDICATES DPH OR P2 SFR TO PCH TRANSITION
WRITE CYCLE
WR
PCL OUT (EVEN IF PROGRAM
MEMORY IS INTERNAL)
DPL OR Rt OUT
P0
PCL OUT (IF PROGRAM
MEMORY IS EXTERNAL
DATA OUT
P2
INDICATES DPH OR P2 SFR TO PCH TRANSITION
PORT OPERATION
MOV PORT SRC
OLD DATA
NEW DATA
P0 PINS SAMPLED
P0 PINS SAMPLED
MOV DEST P0
MOV DEST PORT (P1. P2. P3)
P1, P2, P3 PINS SAMPLED
RXD SAMPLED
P1, P2, P3 PINS SAMPLED
(INCLUDES INTO. INT1. TO T1)
SERIAL PORT SHIFT CLOCK
TXD (MODE 0)
RXD SAMPLED
199
4202D–SCR–06/05
This diagram indicates when signals are clocked internally. The time it takes the signals
to propagate to the pins, however, ranges from 25 to 125 ns. This propagation delay is
dependent on variables such as temperature and pin loading. Propagation also varies
from output to output and component. Typically though (TA=25°C fully loaded) RD and
WR propagation delays are approximately 50 ns. The other signals are typically 85 ns.
Propagation delays are incorporated in the AC specifications.
USB Interface
Rise Time
Fall Time
VHmin
VLmax
90%
90%
VCRS
10%
10%
Differential
Data Lines
tF
tR
Symbol
tR
Parameter
Rise Time
Fall Time
Min
4
Typ(5)
Max
20
Unit
ns
tF
4
20
ns
tFDRATE
VCRS
tDJ1
Full-speed Data Rate
11.9700
1.3
12.0300
2.0
Mb/s
V
Crossover Voltage
Source Jitter Total to next transaction
-3.5
3.5
ns
Source Jitter Total for paired
transactions
tDJ2
-4
4
ns
tJR1
tJR2
Receiver Jitter to next transaction
-18.5
-9
18.5
9
ns
ns
Receiver Jitter for paired transactions
200
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Packaging
Information
Ordering Information
Lead free/ RoHS
Part Number
Supply
Voltage (V)
Max Frequency
Standard
Memory Size
(bytes)
Temperature
Range
Part Number
(MHz)
Package
VQFP64
VQFP64
PLCC28
PLCC28
Packing
Tray
AT83C5122xxx-RDTIM
AT83C5122xxx-RDRIM
AT83C5122xxx-SISIM
AT83C5122xxx-SIRIM
AT83C5122xxx-RDTUM
AT83C5122xxx-RDRUM
AT83C5122xxx-SISUM
AT83C5122xxx-SURIM
32K ROM
32K ROM
32K ROM
32K ROM
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
Industrial
Industrial
Industrial
Industrial
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
Tape & Reel
Stick
Tape & Reel
Tray & Dry
Pack
AT83C5122xxx-PSVIM
AT83C5122xxx-PSFIM
AT83C5122xxx-PSTUM
AT83C5122xxx-PSRUM
32K ROM
32K ROM
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
Industrial
Industrial
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
QFN64
QFN64
Tape & Reel &
Dry Pack
30K ROM +
512 Bytes
EEPROM
AT83EC5122xxx-RDVIM AT83EC5122xxx-RDTUM
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
Industrial
Industrial
Industrial
Industrial
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
VQFP64
VQFP64
QFN64
QFN64
Tray & Dry pack
30K ROM +
512 Bytes
EEPROM
Tape & Reel
& Dry pack
AT83EC5122xxx-
AT83EC5122xxx-RDFIM
RDRUM
30K ROM +
512 Bytes
EEPROM
Tray & Dry
Pack
AT83EC5122xxx-PSVIM AT83EC5122xxx-PSTUM
AT83EC5122xxx-PSFIM AT83EC5122xxx-PSRUM
30K ROM +
512 Bytes
EEPROM
Tape & Reel &
Dry Pack
AT85C5122D-RDTIM
AT85C5122D-RDRIM
AT85C5122D-SISIM
AT85C5122D-SIRIM
AT85C5122D-RDTUM
AT85C5122D-RDRUM
AT85C5122D-SISUM
AT85C5122D-SIRUM
32K CRAM
32K CRAM
32K CRAM
32K CRAM
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
Industrial
Industrial
Industrial
Industrial
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
VQFP64
VQFP64
PLCC28
PLCC28
Tray
Tape & Reel
Stick
Tape & Reel
AT89C5122D-RDVIM(1)
AT89C5122D-RDFIM(1)
AT89C5122D-RDTUM
AT89C5122D-RDRUM
32K FLASH
32K FLASH
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
Industrial
Industrial
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
VQFP64
VQFP64
Tray & Dry pack
Tape & Reel
& Dry pack
Tray & Dry
Pack
AT89C5122D-PSVIM
AT89C5122D-PSFIM
AT89C5122D-PSTUM
AT89C5122D-PSRUM
32K FLASH
32K FLASH
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
Industrial
Industrial
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
QFN64
QFN64
Tape & Reel &
Dry Pack
4202D–SCR–06/05
Lead free/ RoHS
Part Number
Supply
Voltage (V)
Max Frequency
(MHz)
Standard
Memory Size
(bytes)
Temperature
Range
Part Number
Package
Packing
Tray & Dry
Pack
AT89C5122DS-RDVIM
AT89C5122DS-RDFIM
AT89C5122DS-PSVIM
AT89C5122DS-PSFIM
AT89C5122DS-RDTUM
AT89C5122DS-RDRUM
AT89C5122D-PSTUM
AT89C5122D-PSRUM
32K FLASH
32K FLASH
32K FLASH
32K FLASH
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
Industrial
Industrial
Industrial
Industrial
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
VQFP64
Tape & Reel &
Dry Pack
VQFP64
QFN64
QFN64
Tray & Dry
Pack
Tape & Reel &
Dry Pack
AT83C5123xxx-RATIM
AT83C5123xxx-RARIM
AT83C5123xxx-SISIM
AT83C5123xxx-SIRIM
AT83C5123xxx-PUTIM
AT83C5123xxx-PURIM
AT83C5123xxx-RATUM
AT83C5123xxx-RARUM
AT83C5123xxx-SISUM
AT83C5123xxx-SIRUM
AT83C5123xxx-PUTUM
AT83C5123xxx-PURUM
30K ROM
30K ROM
30K ROM
30K ROM
30K ROM
30K ROM
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
Industrial
Industrial
Industrial
Industrial
Industrial
Industrial
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
VQFP32
VQFP32
PLCC28
PLCC28
QFN32
Tray
Tape & Reel
Stick
Tape & Reel
Tray
QFN32
Tape & Reel
30K ROM +
512 Bytes
EEPROM
AT83EC5123xxx-RAVIM AT83EC5123xxx-RATUM
AT83EC5123xxx-RAFIM AT83EC5123xxx-RARUM
AT83EC5123xxx-PUVIM AT83EC5123xxx-PUTUM
AT83EC5123xxx-PUFIM AT83EC5123xxx-PURUM
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
3.6 - 5.5
Industrial
Industrial
Industrial
Industrial
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
48 MHz / X1
VQFP32
VQFP32
QFN32
QFN32
Tray & Dry pack
30K ROM +
512 Bytes
EEPROM
Tape & Reel
& Dry pack
30K ROM +
512 Bytes
EEPROM
Tray & Dry
Pack
30K ROM +
512 Bytes
EEPROM
Tape & Reel &
Dry Pack
Note:
1. Check avaibility with sales office
202
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Mechanical Dimensions
PLCC28 Package
203
4202D–SCR–06/05
VQFP64 Package
204
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
PLCC68 Package
205
4202D–SCR–06/05
VQFP32 Package
206
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
QFN32 Package
207
4202D–SCR–06/05
QFN64 Package
208
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Change Log
Changes from 4202A to 4202B
1. Product AT8xEC5122 added.
2. Products AT83C5123 and AT83EC5123 added.
Changes from 4202B to 4202C
1. All sections updated.
2. QFN64 and QFN32 packages added.
3. SCIB section : VCC must be higher than 4.0V when DC/DC is operated at 5V.
Changes from 4202C to 4202D
1. Product AT89C5122DS added (EA pin changed to VCC)
2. Typical applications section: external pull-up shown on CIO pin
3. Ports section : Detailed explanations on CIO, CC4, CC8 quasi-bidirectional ports
4. Ordering information section: AT89C5122DS part-numbers added
209
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Table of Contents
Features ................................................................................................. 1
Reference Documents.......................................................................................... 2
Product Description .............................................................................................. 3
AT8xC5122 Block Diagram .................................................................................. 5
AT83C5123 Block Diagram ..................................................................................5
Pinout .................................................................................................... 6
High Pin Count Package Description.................................................................... 6
Low Pin Count Package Description .................................................................. 11
Pin Description.................................................................................................... 13
Typical Applications ........................................................................... 17
Recommended External components .................................................................17
USB Keyboard with Smart Card Reader using the AT8xC5122 and AT89C5122DS ver-
sions............................................................................................................................. 18
USB Smart Card Reader using the AT83C5123 version.................................... 19
Memory Organization ......................................................................... 20
Program Memory Managament.......................................................................... 20
Data Memory Managament ................................................................................ 21
Dual Data Pointer Register (DDPTR) ................................................................. 22
Registers............................................................................................................. 24
AT8xC5122’s CRAM and E2PROM versions .....................................................26
AT8xC5122’s ROM version ................................................................................ 30
AT83C5123 version............................................................................................ 32
Special Function Registers (SFR’s) .................................................. 33
Introduction......................................................................................................... 33
AT8xC5122 Version............................................................................................ 34
AT83C5123 Version ........................................................................................... 35
SFR’s Description............................................................................................... 36
Clock Controller .................................................................................. 41
On-Chip Oscillator .............................................................................................. 41
Phase Lock Loop (PLL) ...................................................................................... 42
Clock Tree Architecture ...................................................................................... 43
Registers............................................................................................................. 50
I/O Port Definition ............................................................................... 53
Port Configuration............................................................................................... 57
Registers............................................................................................................. 61
Smart Card Interface Block (SCIB) ................................................... 64
Block Diagram .................................................................................................... 65
210
4202D–SCR–06/05
Definitions........................................................................................................... 65
Functional Description ........................................................................................ 67
Additional Features............................................................................................. 74
Alternate Card..................................................................................................... 78
Registers .............................................................................................................78
DC/DC Converter................................................................................................ 88
USB Controller .................................................................................... 95
Description.......................................................................................................... 96
Configuration ...................................................................................................... 99
Read/Write Data FIFO...................................................................................... 102
Bulk / Interrupt Transactions............................................................................. 103
Control Transactions......................................................................................... 107
Isochronous Transactions................................................................................. 108
Miscellaneous................................................................................................... 110
Suspend/Resume Management .......................................................................111
Detach Simulation............................................................................................. 114
USB Interrupt System....................................................................................... 115
Registers........................................................................................................... 117
Serial I/O Port .................................................................................... 126
Framing Error Detection ................................................................................... 126
Automatic Address Recognition........................................................................ 127
Asynchronous Modes (Modes 1, 2 and 3)........................................................ 131
Modes 2 and 3.................................................................................................. 132
Registers........................................................................................................... 135
Serial Port Interface (SPI) ................................................................ 137
Features............................................................................................................ 137
Signal Description............................................................................................. 137
Functional Description ...................................................................................... 139
Timers/Counters ............................................................................... 147
Timer/Counter Operations ................................................................................ 147
Timer 0.............................................................................................................. 147
Timer 1.............................................................................................................. 150
Registers........................................................................................................... 152
Keyboard Interface ........................................................................... 155
Introduction....................................................................................................... 155
Description........................................................................................................ 155
Registers........................................................................................................... 156
Interrupt System ............................................................................... 159
Introduction....................................................................................................... 159
Interrupt System Description ............................................................................ 159
211
AT8xC5122/23
4202D–SCR–06/05
AT8xC5122/23
Registers........................................................................................................... 162
Interrupt Sources and Vectors.......................................................................... 171
Microcontroller Reset ....................................................................... 172
Introduction....................................................................................................... 172
Power On Reset (POR) .................................................................................... 173
Power Fail Detector (PFD)................................................................................ 173
Reset pin........................................................................................................... 175
Watchdog Timer ............................................................................................... 177
Power Management .......................................................................... 180
Idle Mode.......................................................................................................... 180
Power Down Mode ........................................................................................... 180
Reduced EMI Mode.......................................................................................... 181
USB Interface ................................................................................................... 182
Smart Card Interface ........................................................................................ 183
Keyboard Interface ........................................................................................... 184
Watchdog Timer during Power-down and Idle Mode........................................ 184
Registers........................................................................................................... 185
Electrical Characteristics ................................................................. 186
Absolute Maximum Ratings ..............................................................................186
DC Parameters .................................................................................................186
LED’s ................................................................................................................188
Smart Card Interface ........................................................................................ 189
USB Interface ................................................................................................... 192
AC Parameters ................................................................................................. 193
Float Waveforms............................................................................................... 199
Packaging Information ..................................................................... 201
Ordering Information......................................................................................... 201
Mechanical Dimensions.................................................................................... 203
Change Log ....................................................................................... 209
Changes from 4202A to 4202B ........................................................................209
Changes from 4202B to 4202C ........................................................................209
Changes from 4202C to 4202D ........................................................................209
Table of Contents ............................................................................. 210
212
4202D–SCR–06/05
Atmel Corporation
Atmel Operations
2325 Orchard Parkway
San Jose, CA 95131, USA
Tel: 1(408) 441-0311
Fax: 1(408) 487-2600
Memory
RF/Automotive
2325 Orchard Parkway
San Jose, CA 95131, USA
Tel: 1(408) 441-0311
Fax: 1(408) 436-4314
Theresienstrasse 2
Postfach 3535
74025 Heilbronn, Germany
Tel: (49) 71-31-67-0
Fax: (49) 71-31-67-2340
Regional Headquarters
Microcontrollers
2325 Orchard Parkway
San Jose, CA 95131, USA
Tel: 1(408) 441-0311
Fax: 1(408) 436-4314
1150 East Cheyenne Mtn. Blvd.
Colorado Springs, CO 80906, USA
Tel: 1(719) 576-3300
Europe
Atmel Sarl
Route des Arsenaux 41
Case Postale 80
CH-1705 Fribourg
Switzerland
Fax: 1(719) 540-1759
Biometrics/Imaging/Hi-Rel MPU/
High Speed Converters/RF Datacom
Avenue de Rochepleine
BP 123
38521 Saint-Egreve Cedex, France
Tel: (33) 4-76-58-30-00
Fax: (33) 4-76-58-34-80
La Chantrerie
BP 70602
44306 Nantes Cedex 3, France
Tel: (33) 2-40-18-18-18
Fax: (33) 2-40-18-19-60
Tel: (41) 26-426-5555
Fax: (41) 26-426-5500
Asia
Room 1219
ASIC/ASSP/Smart Cards
Zone Industrielle
13106 Rousset Cedex, France
Tel: (33) 4-42-53-60-00
Fax: (33) 4-42-53-60-01
Chinachem Golden Plaza
77 Mody Road Tsimshatsui
East Kowloon
Hong Kong
Tel: (852) 2721-9778
Fax: (852) 2722-1369
1150 East Cheyenne Mtn. Blvd.
Colorado Springs, CO 80906, USA
Tel: 1(719) 576-3300
Japan
9F, Tonetsu Shinkawa Bldg.
1-24-8 Shinkawa
Chuo-ku, Tokyo 104-0033
Japan
Fax: 1(719) 540-1759
Scottish Enterprise Technology Park
Maxwell Building
Tel: (81) 3-3523-3551
Fax: (81) 3-3523-7581
East Kilbride G75 0QR, Scotland
Tel: (44) 1355-803-000
Fax: (44) 1355-242-743
Literature Requests
www.atmel.com/literature
Disclaimer: The information in this document is provided in connection with Atmel products. No license, express or implied, by estoppel or otherwise, to any
intellectual property right is granted by this document or in connection with the sale of Atmel products. EXCEPT AS SET FORTH IN ATMEL’S TERMS AND CONDI-
TIONS OF SALE LOCATED ON ATMEL’S WEB SITE, ATMEL ASSUMES NO LIABILITY WHATSOEVER AND DISCLAIMS ANY EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY
WARRANTY RELATING TO ITS PRODUCTS INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE, OR NON-INFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL ATMEL BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE, SPECIAL OR INCIDEN-
TAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF PROFITS, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION, OR LOSS OF INFORMATION) ARISING OUT
OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THIS DOCUMENT, EVEN IF ATMEL HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. Atmel makes no
representations or warranties with respect to the accuracy or completeness of the contents of this document and reserves the right to make changes to specifications
and product descriptions at any time without notice. Atmel does not make any commitment to update the information contained herein. Unless specifically provided
otherwise, Atmel products are not suitable for, and shall not be used in, automotive applications. Atmel’s products are not intended, authorized, or warranted for use as compo-
nents in applications intended to support or sustain life.
© Atmel Corporation 2005. All rights reserved. Atmel®, logo and combinations thereof, are registered trademarks, and Everywhere You Are®
are the trademarks of Atmel Corporation or its subsidiaries. Other terms and product names may be trademarks of others.
Printed on recycled paper.
4202D–SCR–06/05
相关型号:
AT83C5122XXX-RDRUM
Microcontroller, 8-Bit, MROM, 8051 CPU, 24MHz, CMOS, PQFP64, ROHS COMPLIANT, VQFP-64
ATMEL
AT83C5122XXX-RDTUM
Microcontroller, 8-Bit, MROM, 8051 CPU, 24MHz, CMOS, PQFP64, ROHS COMPLIANT, VQFP-64
ATMEL
AT83C5122XXX-SURIM
Microcontroller, 8-Bit, MROM, 24MHz, CMOS, PQCC28, ROHS COMPLIANT, PLASTIC, LCC-28
ATMEL
©2020 ICPDF网 联系我们和版权申明